blob: fc4f3a4cf266564ef38e9cb28ef718eee7811e1d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau29698e32022-05-31 17:05:27 +02005 version 2.7
Willy Tarreauf5320192022-08-20 15:56:31 +02006 2022/08/20
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001239.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
193This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
194streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200198
199HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200200head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200201streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
202other streams.
203
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
205connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
206leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
208processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
209waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200211HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100212 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
213 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100214 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200216 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100217
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219
2201.2. HTTP request
221-----------------
222
223First, let's consider this HTTP request :
224
225 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100226 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
228 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
229 3 User-agent: my small browser
230 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
231 5 Accept: image/png
232
233
2341.2.1. The Request line
235-----------------------
236
237Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
238
239 - a METHOD : GET
240 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
242
243All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
244which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
245followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
246is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
247desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
248the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
249
250The URI itself can have several forms :
251
252 - A "relative URI" :
253
254 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
257 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
258
259 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
260
261 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
262
263 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
264 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
265 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
266 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
267 must accept this form too.
268
269 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
270 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
271 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
274 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
275 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
276 other protocols too.
277
278In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
279mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
280on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
281It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
282specific to the language, framework or application in use.
283
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100285assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.2.2. The request headers
289--------------------------
290
291The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
292beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
293an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
294Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
295values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
296encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
297the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
298define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100300Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100302"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200303as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
304normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
305representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
306HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307
308The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
309that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
310is one valid form of empty line.
311
312Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
313headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
314about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
315application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
316
317Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000318 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
320 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
321 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
322
323
3241.3. HTTP response
325------------------
326
327An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
328messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
329
330 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100331 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
333 2 Content-length: 350
334 3 Content-Type: text/html
335
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
337codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
338response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100339continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
340the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
341following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
342sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
343(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
344correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
345such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
346state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400347over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100348if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
349information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353------------------------
354
355Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
356
357 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
358 - a status code : 200
359 - a reason : OK
360
361The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100362 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
363 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
364 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
365 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
366 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000368Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100369"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
371messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
372or "Authentication Required".
373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100374HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375
376 Code When / reason
377 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
378 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
379 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100381 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 400 for an invalid or too large request
384 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
385 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100387 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100389 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
390 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400391 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200392 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400393 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100394 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200396 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200397 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
398 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
399 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
400
401The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4024.2).
403
404
4051.3.2. The response headers
406---------------------------
407
408Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
409the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
410details.
411
412
4132. Configuring HAProxy
414----------------------
415
4162.1. Configuration file format
417------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
419HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
420
421 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700423 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100424 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100426The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
427a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
430
431 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
432
433 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
434 tab characters
435
436 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
437 keyword sequences listed in this document
438
439 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
440 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
441 parts of the configuration, or expressions
442
443 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
444 are supported
445
446 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
447 section
448
449This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
450generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
451figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
452
453First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
454the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
455a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
456word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
457follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
458the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
459the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
460the parts that need to be addressed.
461
462A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
463requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
464extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
465the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
466section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
467section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
468not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
469
470A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
471each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
472a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
473start a new one.
474
475Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
476that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
477applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
478"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
479processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
480ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
481which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
482In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
483of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
484identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
485such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4862, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
487
488 listen foo
489 bind :80
490
491 listen bar
492 bind :81
493
494Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
495spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
496of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
497following configurations are strictly equivalent:
498
499 global#this is the global section
500 daemon#daemonize
501 frontend foo
502 mode http # or tcp
503
504and:
505
506 global
507 daemon
508
509 # this is the public web frontend
510 frontend foo
511 mode http
512
513The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
514new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
515other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
516section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
517section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
518at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
519
520Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
521are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
522editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
523support automatic indent.
524
525In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
526positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
527modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
528anymore, and is not recommended.
529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200530
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005312.2. Quoting and escaping
532-------------------------
533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
535that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
536possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
537in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
538('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
541very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
542the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
543also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
544delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
545word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
546remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100548If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
549(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
550
551Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
552backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200553
554 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
555 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
556 \\ to use a backslash
557 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
558 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
559
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100560In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
561C-language representation:
562
563 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
564 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
565 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
566 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
567
568Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
569or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
570of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200571
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100572 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
574 # hash as a comment start
575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
577evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
578dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
579backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200580
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100581Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
582character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
583is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
586entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
587name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
588represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
589hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100591 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
592 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
593 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
594 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
595 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
596 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
597 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
598 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
599 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
600 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
601 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200602
603 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200605 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
606 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
607 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
608 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
609 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
610
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100611There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
612necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
613by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
614they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
615escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
616characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
617case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
618if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
619own quotes.
620
621The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600622quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500623not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100624quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
625
626Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
627arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
628
629 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
631
632Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
633"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
634cannot write:
635
636 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
637
638because we would like the string to cut like this:
639
640 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
641 |---------|----|-|
642 arg1 _/ / /
643 arg2 __________/ /
644 arg3 ______________/
645
646but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
647parenthesis then garbage:
648
649 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
650 |--------|--------|
651 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
652 trailing garbage _________/
653
654The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
655quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
656processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
657this word:
658
659 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
660 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
661 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
662
663So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
664still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
665the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
666the second level:
667
668 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
669 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 |---------||----|-|
672 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
673 arg2=blah ___________/ /
674 arg3=g _______________/
675
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500676Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100677double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
678
679 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
680 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
681 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
682 |---------||----|-|
683 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
684 arg2 ___________/ /
685 arg3 _______________/
686
687When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
688appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
689string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
690thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
691
692 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
693 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
694 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
695 |-------------| |-----||-|
696 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
697 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
698 arg3 ______________________/
699
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400700Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600701that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100702quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
703single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
704level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
705
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600706Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
707if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
708or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
709
710 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
711 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
712 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
713
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100714When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
715double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600716and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100717a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
718a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
719the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
720regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
721around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
722more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200723
724
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007252.3. Environment variables
726--------------------------
727
728HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
729interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
730configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
731optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
732shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200733underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
734list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
735arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100736before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
737use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
738next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
739existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 Example:
742
743 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
744
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100745 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200746
747 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
748
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200749Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
750file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200751
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
753 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
754
755* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
756 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
757 directory.
758
759* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
760
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500761* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200762 processes, separated by semicolons.
763
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500764* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200765 CLI, separated by semicolons.
766
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200767In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
768regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
769only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
770
771* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
772
773* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
774 starting at one.
775
776* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
777 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
778 first section.
779
780These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
781if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
782section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
783"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
784proxies.
785
786This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
787logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
788to name some config objects like servers for example.
789
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200790See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200791
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100792
7932.4. Conditional blocks
794-----------------------
795
796It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
797some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
798ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
799configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
800versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
801preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
802text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
803lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
804switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
805are defined to form conditional blocks:
806
807 - .if <condition>
808 - .elif <condition>
809 - .else
810 - .endif
811
812The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
813as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
814matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
815there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
816only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
817".elif" of a block.
818
819Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
820ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
821as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
822
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200823Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
824See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
825
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200826The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
827expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100828
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100829 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
830 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200831 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200832 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530833 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
834 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200835 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
836 from left to right until one returns false
837 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
838 from right to left until one returns true
839
840Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
841operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200842
843The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
844
845 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
846 exists, regardless of its contents
847
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200848 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
849 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
850 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
851
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200852 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
853 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
854
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200855 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
856 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
857 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
858 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
859
860 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
861 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
862 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
863 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
864
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200865Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200867 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
868 listen mwcli_px
869 bind :1111
870 ...
871 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100872
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200873 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
874 bind :80
875 .endif
876
877 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200878 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200879 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200880 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200881 .endif
882
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200883 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200884 bind :443 ssl crt ...
885 .endif
886
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200887 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
888 profiling.memory on
889 .endif
890
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200891 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
892 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
893 .endif
894
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200895Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100896
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200897 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100898 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
899 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
900 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
901
902Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
903"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
904fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
905provide advice to the user.
906
907Example:
908
909 .if "${A}"
910 .if "${B}"
911 .notice "A=1, B=1"
912 .elif "${C}"
913 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
914 .elif "${D}"
915 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
916 .else
917 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
918 .endif
919 .else
920 .notice "A=0"
921 .endif
922
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200923 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
924 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
925
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100926
9272.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200928----------------
929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100930Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100931values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
932otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
933numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
934for every keyword. Supported units are :
935
936 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
937 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
938 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
939 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
940 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
941 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
942
943
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009442.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200945-------------
946
947 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
948 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
949 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
950 global
951 daemon
952 maxconn 256
953
954 defaults
955 mode http
956 timeout connect 5000ms
957 timeout client 50000ms
958 timeout server 50000ms
959
960 frontend http-in
961 bind *:80
962 default_backend servers
963
964 backend servers
965 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
966
967
968 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
969 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
970 global
971 daemon
972 maxconn 256
973
974 defaults
975 mode http
976 timeout connect 5000ms
977 timeout client 50000ms
978 timeout server 50000ms
979
980 listen http-in
981 bind *:80
982 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
983
984
985Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
986
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100987 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200988
989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009903. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200991--------------------
992
993Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
994are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
995of them have command-line equivalents.
996
997The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
998
999 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001000 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001001 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001002 - cluster-secret
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001003 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001004 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001006 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001007 - description
1008 - deviceatlas-json-file
1009 - deviceatlas-log-level
1010 - deviceatlas-separator
1011 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001012 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001013 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001014 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001015 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001016 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001017 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001018 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001019 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1020 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1021 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1022 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001023 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001024 - h1-case-adjust
1025 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001026 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001027 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001028 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001029 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001030 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001032 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001033 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001034 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001035 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001036 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001037 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001038 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001039 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001040 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001041 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001042 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001043 - presetenv
1044 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001045 - uid
1046 - ulimit-n
1047 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001048 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001049 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001050 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001051 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001052 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001053 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001054 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001055 - ssl-default-bind-options
1056 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001057 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001058 - ssl-default-server-options
1059 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001060 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001061 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001062 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001063 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001064 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001065 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001066 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001067 - 51degrees-data-file
1068 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001069 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001070 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001071 - wurfl-data-file
1072 - wurfl-information-list
1073 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001074 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001075 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001076
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001078 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001079 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001080 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001081 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001082 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001083 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001084 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001085 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001086 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001087 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001088 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001089 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090 - noepoll
1091 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001092 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001094 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001095 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001096 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001097 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001098 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001099 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001100 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001101 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001102 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001103 - tune.buffers.limit
1104 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001105 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001106 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001107 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001108 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001109 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001110 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001111 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001112 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001113 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001114 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001115 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001116 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001117 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001118 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1119 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001120 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001121 - tune.maxaccept
1122 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001123 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001124 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001125 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001126 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001127 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1128 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001129 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001130 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001131 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001132 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001133 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1134 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001135 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001136 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001137 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001138 - tune.sndbuf.client
1139 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001140 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001141 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1142 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001143 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001144 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1145 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001146 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001147 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001148 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1149 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001150 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001151 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001152 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1153 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1154 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001155 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1156 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001157
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001160 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001161
1162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011633.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001164------------------------------------
1165
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001166ca-base <dir>
1167 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001168 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1169 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1170 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001171
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001172chroot <jail dir>
1173 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1174 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1175 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1176 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1177 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001178 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001179
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001180cluster-secret <secret>
1181 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1182 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1183 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
Frédéric Lécaillead20a562022-05-16 16:51:41 +02001184 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
1185 tokens. If you do not set this parameter, the stateless reset and Retry QUIC
1186 features will be both silently disabled.
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001187
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001188close-spread-time <time>
1189 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1190 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1191 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1192 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1193 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1194 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1195 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1196 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001197 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1198 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1199 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1200 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1201 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001202
1203 Arguments :
1204 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001205 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1206 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001207
1208 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1209 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1210 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1211
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001212 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001213
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001214cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1215 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1216 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1217 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1218 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1219 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001220
1221 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1222
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001223 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001224 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1225 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1226 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1227 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1228 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1229 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1230 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
1231 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside
1232 of Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1233 either 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the
1234 processes or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously,
1235 multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will
1236 replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001237
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001238 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1239 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1240 on the machine's word size.
1241
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001242 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1243 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001244 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1245 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001246 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001247 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1248 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001249
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001250 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1251 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1252 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1253 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1254 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001255
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001256 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001257 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001258 # first 4 CPUs
1259
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001260 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1261 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001262 # word size.
1263
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001264 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001265 # and so on.
1266 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1267 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1268 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1269
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001270 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1271 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1272 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1273 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001274
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001275 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1276 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1277 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001278
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001279 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1280 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1281 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1282 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1283 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1284
1285 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1286 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1287 # group may have more than 64 threads.
1288 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39 80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1289 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39 80-119
1290 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79 120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1291 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79 120-159
1292
1293
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001294crt-base <dir>
1295 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001296 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1297 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001298
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001299daemon
1300 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1301 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001302 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1303 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001304
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001305default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001306 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001307 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1308 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1309 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1310 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1311 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1312 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1313 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1314 not start with a slash ('/'):
1315 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1316 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1317
1318 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1319 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1320 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1321 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1322 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1323 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1324 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1325 each of them.
1326
1327 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1328 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1329 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1330 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1331 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1332 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1333 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1334 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1335
1336 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1337 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001338 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001339 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1340 made easily relocatable.
1341
1342 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1343 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1344 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1345 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1346 consistent across all configuration files.
1347
1348 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1349 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1350 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1351 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1352 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1353 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1354 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1355 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1356
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001357deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1358 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001359 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001360
1361deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001362 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001363 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1364
1365deviceatlas-separator <char>
1366 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1367 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1368
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001369deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001370 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1371 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1372 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001373
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001374expose-experimental-directives
1375 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1376 the config file will be rejected.
1377
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001378external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001379 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1380 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001381 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1382 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1383 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1384 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1385 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001386
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001387fd-hard-limit <number>
1388 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1389 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1390 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1391 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1392 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1393 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1394 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1395 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1396 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1397 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1398 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1399 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1400
1401 global
1402 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1403 fd-hard-limit 50000
1404
1405 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1406
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001407gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001408 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001409 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1410 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001411 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001412 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001413 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001414
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001415grace <time>
1416 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1417
1418 Arguments :
1419 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1420 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1421 soft-stop operation.
1422
1423 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1424 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1425 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1426 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1427 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1428 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1429 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1430 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1431 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1432
1433 Example:
1434
1435 global
1436 grace 10s
1437
1438 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1439 frontend ext-check
1440 bind :9999
1441 monitor-uri /ext-check
1442 monitor fail if { stopping }
1443
1444 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1445 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1446 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1447 SIGUSR1 signal.
1448
1449 Example:
1450
1451 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1452 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1453 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1454 frontend ext-check
1455 bind :9999
1456 monitor-uri /ext-check
1457 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1458
1459 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1460
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001461group <group name>
1462 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1463 See also "gid" and "user".
1464
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001465hard-stop-after <time>
1466 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1467
1468 Arguments :
1469 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1470 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1471 SIGUSR1 signal.
1472
1473 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1474 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1475 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1476
1477 Example:
1478 global
1479 hard-stop-after 30s
1480
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001481 See also: grace
1482
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001483h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1484 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1485
1486 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1487 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1488 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1489 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1490 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1491 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1492 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1493
1494 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1495 option may be set.
1496
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001497h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1498 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1499 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1500 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1501 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001502 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001503 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1504 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1505 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1506 specified in a proxy.
1507
1508 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1509 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1510 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1511 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1512 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1513 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1514 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1515
1516 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1517 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1518 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1519 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1520 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1521
1522 Example:
1523 global
1524 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1525
1526 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1527 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1528
1529h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1530 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1531 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1532 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1533 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1534 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1535 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1536 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1537 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1538
1539 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1540 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1541 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1542
1543 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1544 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1545
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001546httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1547 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1548 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1549 server line.
1550
1551 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1552 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1553 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1554
1555 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1556 configuration error if it fails.
1557
1558httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1559 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1560 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1561
1562 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1563 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1564
1565 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1566 configuration error if it fails.
1567
1568httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1569 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1570 to resolve.
1571
1572 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1573 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1574
1575 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1576 configuration error if it fails to load.
1577
1578httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1579 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1580 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1581 option is "ipv6".
1582
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001583insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001584 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001585 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1586 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1587 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1588 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1589 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1590 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1591 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001592 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001593 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1594 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1595 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1596 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1597 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1598 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1599 disable it.
1600
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001601insecure-setuid-wanted
1602 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1603 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1604 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1605 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001606 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001607 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001608 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001609 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1610 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001611 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001612 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1613 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1614 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1615 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1616
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001617issuers-chain-path <dir>
1618 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1619 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1620 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001621 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001622 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1623 "issuers-chain-path".
1624 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1625 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1626 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1627 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1628 will share the chain in memory.
1629
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001630h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1631 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1632 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1633 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1634 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1635 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1636 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1637 the keyword with "no'.
1638
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001639localpeer <name>
1640 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1641 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1642 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1643 the configuration parsing.
1644
1645 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1646 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1647
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001648log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001649 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001650 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001651 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001652 configured with "log global".
1653
1654 <address> can be one of:
1655
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001656 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001657 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1658 port).
1659
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001660 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1661 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1662 port).
1663
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001664 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001665 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1666 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001667 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001668
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001669 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1670 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1671 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1672 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1673 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1674 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1675 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1676 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1677 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1678 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001679 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001680 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1681 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1682 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001683 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1684 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001685
1686 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1687 "fd@2", see above.
1688
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001689 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1690 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1691 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1692 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1693 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1694
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001695 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1696 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001697
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001698 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1699 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1700 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1701 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1702 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1703 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1704 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1705 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1706 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1707 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001708 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1709 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001710
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001711 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1712 one of the following :
1713
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001714 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1715 field is stripped. This is the default.
1716 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1717 rfc3164.
1718
1719 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001720 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1721
1722 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1723 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1724
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001725 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1726 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1727 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1728 designed to be used with a local log server.
1729
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001730 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1731 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1732 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1733 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1734 logger consumes.
1735
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001736 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1737 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1738 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1739 used with a local log server.
1740
1741 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1742 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1743 designed to be used with a local log server.
1744
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001745 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1746 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1747 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1748 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1749
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001750 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1751 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1752 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1753 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1754 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1755
1756 <sample_size>
1757 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1758 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1759 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1760 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1761 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1762
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001763 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001764
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001765 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1766 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1767 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1768
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001769 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1770 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1771 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1772 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001773
1774 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001775 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1776 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1777 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1778 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1779 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1780 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001781
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001782 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001783
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001784log-send-hostname [<string>]
1785 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1786 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1787 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1788 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1789 the logs.
1790
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001791log-tag <string>
1792 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1793 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1794 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001795 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001796
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001797lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001798 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1799 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1800 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1801 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1802 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1803 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001804 used multiple times.
1805
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001806lua-load-per-thread <file>
1807 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1808 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1809 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1810 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1811 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1812 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1813 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1814 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1815 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1816 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1817 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1818 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1819 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1820 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1821 times.
1822
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001823lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1824 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1825 variable.
1826 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1827 to "path".
1828
1829 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1830 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1831 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1832 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1833 will be checked earlier.
1834
1835 As an example by specifying the following path:
1836
1837 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1838 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1839
1840 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1841 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1842 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1843 paths if that does not exist either.
1844
1845 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1846 documentation.
1847
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001848master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001849 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1850 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1851 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001852 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001853 or daemon mode.
1854
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001855 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1856 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1857 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1858 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1859 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001860
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001861 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001862
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001863mworker-max-reloads <number>
1864 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001865 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001866 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1867 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1868 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1869
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001870nbthread <number>
1871 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001872 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1873 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1874 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1875 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1876 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1877 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1878 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001879
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001880numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001881 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1882 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1883 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1884 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
1885 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
1886 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
1887 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
1888 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
1889 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
1890 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001891
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001892pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001893 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1894 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1895 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1896 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001897
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001898pp2-never-send-local
1899 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1900 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1901 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1902 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1903 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1904 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1905 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1906 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1907 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1908 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1909 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1910
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001911presetenv <name> <value>
1912 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1913 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1914 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1915 and "unsetenv".
1916
1917resetenv [<name> ...]
1918 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1919 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1920 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1921 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1922 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1923 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1924 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1925 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1926
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001927server-state-base <directory>
1928 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001929 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1930 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001931
1932server-state-file <file>
1933 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1934 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1935 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1936 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1937 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1938 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1939 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1940 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001941 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1942 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001943
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001944set-var <var-name> <expr>
1945 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1946 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1947 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1948 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1949 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1950 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001951 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001952 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1953 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1954
1955 Example:
1956 global
1957 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1958 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1959 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1960
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001961set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1962 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1963 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1964 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1965 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1966 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1967 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1968 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1969 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1970 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1971 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1972
1973 Example:
1974 global
1975 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1976 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1977
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001978setenv <name> <value>
1979 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1980 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1981 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1982 and "unsetenv".
1983
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001984set-dumpable
1985 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001986 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1987 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1988 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1989 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1990 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1991 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1992 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1993 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1994 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1995 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1996 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1997 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1998 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1999 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2000 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002001 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01002002 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02002003
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002004ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2006 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002007 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002008 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002009 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2010 information and recommendations see e.g.
2011 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2012 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2013 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2014 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002015
2016ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2017 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2018 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2019 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2020 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2021 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002022 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2023 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2024 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002025 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002026
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002027ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2029 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2030 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2031 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2032 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2033
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002034ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2035 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2036 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2037 keyword to see available options.
2038
2039 Example:
2040 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002041 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002042
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002043ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2044 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2045 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002046 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002047 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002048 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2049 information and recommendations see e.g.
2050 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2051 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2052 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2053 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2054 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002055
2056ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2057 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2058 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2059 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2060 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2061 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002062 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2063 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2064 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2065 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002066
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002067ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2068 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2069 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2070 keyword to see available options.
2071
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002072ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2073 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2074 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2075 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002076 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002077 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002078 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002079 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2080 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2081 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2082 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002083 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2084 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2085 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2086
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002087ssl-propquery <query>
2088 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2089 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2090 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2091 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2092 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2093 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2094 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2095 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2096 was not found.
2097
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002098ssl-provider <name>
2099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2100 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2101 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2102 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2103 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2104 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002105
2106 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002107 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2108 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2109 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2110 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2111 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002112
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002113 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2114 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2115 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2116 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002117
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002118 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2119
2120ssl-provider-path <path>
2121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2122 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2123 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2124 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2125 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2126 defined.
2127 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002128
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002129ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2130 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2131 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002132 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002133 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002134 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2135
2136 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002137
2138 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2139 and won't try to remove them.
2140
2141 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2142
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002143ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002144 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002145 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2146 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2147 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002148
2149 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2150 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2151 optimize the startup time.
2152
2153 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2154 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2155 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2156
2157 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002158 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002159
2160 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002161 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2162 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002163
2164 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2165 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2166 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2167 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2168 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002169 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002170
2171 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002172 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002173 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2174 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2175 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2176 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2177 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002178 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002179
2180 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2181
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002182 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002183 a cert bundle.
2184
2185 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2186 separately in several "crt".
2187
2188 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2189 since files are loading separately.
2190
2191 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2192 required to commit them.
2193
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002194 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002195 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002196
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002197 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2198 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2199 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002201 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2202 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2203 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002204
2205 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002206 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2207 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002208
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002209 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2210 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2211
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002212 The default behavior is "all".
2213
2214 Example:
2215 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2216 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2217 ssl-load-extra-files none
2218
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002219 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2220 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002221
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002222ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2223 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2224 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2225 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2226
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002227ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002228 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002229 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2230 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2231 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2232 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2233 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2234 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002235 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002236
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002237stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2238 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2239 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2240 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002241 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002242 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002243
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002244 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2245 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2246 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002247
2248stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2249 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2250 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002251 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002252
2253stats maxconn <connections>
2254 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2255 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2256
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002257thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2258 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2259 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2260 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2261 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2262 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2263 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2264 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2265 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2266 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2267
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002268thread-groups <number>
2269 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2270 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002271 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2272 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2273 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2274 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2275 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002276
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002277uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002278 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002279 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2280 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2281 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2282
2283ulimit-n <number>
2284 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2285 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002286 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2287 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002288
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002289 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2290 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2291 manually specify this value.
2292
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002293 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2294
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002295unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2296 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2297
2298 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2299 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2300 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2301 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2302 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002303 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002304 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2305 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2306 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2307 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2308
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002309unsetenv [<name> ...]
2310 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2311 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2312 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2313 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2314 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2315 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2316 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2317
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002318user <user name>
2319 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2320 See also "uid" and "group".
2321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002322node <name>
2323 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2324
2325 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2326 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2327 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2328 traffic.
2329
2330description <text>
2331 Add a text that describes the instance.
2332
2333 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2334 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2335 "<" and ">" characters.
2336
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100233751degrees-data-file <file path>
2338 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002339 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002340
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002341 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002342 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2343
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000234451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002345 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2346 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2347 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2348
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002349 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002350 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2351
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200235251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002353 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2354 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2355
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002356 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002357 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2358
235951degrees-cache-size <number>
2360 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2361 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2362 By default, this cache is disabled.
2363
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002364 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002365 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2366
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002367wurfl-data-file <file path>
2368 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2369 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2370
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002371 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002372 with USE_WURFL=1.
2373
2374wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2375 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2376 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2377 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2378
2379 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2380
2381 Valid WURFL properties are:
2382 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2383
2384 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2385 device.
2386
2387 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2388 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2389
2390 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2391 particular web request.
2392
2393 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2394 used Libwurfl API version.
2395
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002396 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2397 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2398
2399 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2400 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2401
2402 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2403
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002404 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002405 with USE_WURFL=1.
2406
2407wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2408 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2409 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2410
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002411 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002412 with USE_WURFL=1.
2413
2414wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2415 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2416 thus before the chroot.
2417
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002418 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002419 with USE_WURFL=1.
2420
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002421wurfl-cache-size <size>
2422 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2423 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002424 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002425 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002426
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002427 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002428 with USE_WURFL=1.
2429
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002430strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002431 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002432 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2433 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002434 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002435 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024373.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002438-----------------------
2439
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002440busy-polling
2441 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2442 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2443 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2444 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2445 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2446 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2447 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2448 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2449 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2450 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2451 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2452 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2453 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2454 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2455 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2456 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2457 "poll" pollers.
2458
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002459 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2460 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2461 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2462
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002463max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002464 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002465 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2466 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2467 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2468 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2469 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2470 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2471 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2472
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002473maxconn <number>
2474 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2475 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2476 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002477 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2478 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2479 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2480 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002481 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2482 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2483 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2484 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2485 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002486 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2487
2488 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002489
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002490maxconnrate <number>
2491 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2492 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2493 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2494 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2495 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2496 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2497 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2498 fairness.
2499
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002500maxcomprate <number>
2501 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002502 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002503 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2504 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2505 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002506 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002507 default value.
2508
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002509maxcompcpuusage <number>
2510 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2511 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2512 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002513 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2514 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2515 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2516 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002517
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002518maxpipes <number>
2519 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2520 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2521 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2522 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2523 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2524 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2525
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002526maxsessrate <number>
2527 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2528 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2529 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2530 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2531 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2532 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2533 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2534 fairness.
2535
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002536maxsslconn <number>
2537 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2538 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2539 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2540 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2541 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2542 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2543 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002544 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2545 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2546 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2547 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002548 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002549 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2550 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002551
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002552maxsslrate <number>
2553 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2554 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2555 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2556 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2557 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2558 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2559 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2560 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2561 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2562 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2563
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002564maxzlibmem <number>
2565 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2566 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2567 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002568 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2569 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2570 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2571
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002572no-memory-trimming
2573 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2574 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2575 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2576 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2577 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2578 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2579 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2580 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2581 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2582 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2583 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2584 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2585 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2586 not suffer from such a problem.
2587
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002588noepoll
2589 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2590 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002591 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002592
2593nokqueue
2594 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2595 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2596 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2597
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002598noevports
2599 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2600 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2601 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2602 also "nopoll".
2603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002604nopoll
2605 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2606 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002608 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2609 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002610
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002611nosplice
2612 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002613 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002614 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002615 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002616 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2617 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2618 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2619 "option splice-response".
2620
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002621nogetaddrinfo
2622 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2623 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2624
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002625noreuseport
2626 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2627 command line argument "-dR".
2628
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002629profiling.memory { on | off }
2630 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2631 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2632 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2633 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2634 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2635 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2636 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2637 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2638 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2639
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002640profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2641 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2642 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2643 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2644 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002645 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002646 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2647 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2648 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2649 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2650
2651 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2652 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2653 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2654 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2655 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002656 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2657 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2658 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2659 CLI.
2660
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002661spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002662 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2663 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2664 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2665 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2666 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2667 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002668
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002669ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002670 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002671 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002672 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002673 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002674 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2675 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2676 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002677 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2678 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002679 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2680 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2681 openssl configuration file uses:
2682 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2683
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002684ssl-mode-async
2685 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002686 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002687 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2688 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002689 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002690 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002691 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002692
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002693tune.buffers.limit <number>
2694 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2695 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2696 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2697 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2698 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002699 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002700 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2701 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2702 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2703 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2704 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2705 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2706 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2707 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002708 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002709
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002710tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2711 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2712 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2713 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002714 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002715
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002716tune.bufsize <number>
2717 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2718 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2719 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2720 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2721 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2722 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2723 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002724 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2725 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002726 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002727 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002728 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002729 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2730 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002731
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002732tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2733 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2734 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2735 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2736 this value. The default value is 1.
2737
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002738tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002739 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2740 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2741 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2742 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002743
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002744tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2745 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2746 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2747 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2748 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2749 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2750
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002751tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2752 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2753 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2754 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2755 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2756 change it.
2757
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002758tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2759 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002760 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002761 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Glenn Strauss0012f892022-06-04 22:11:50 -04002762 The default value is 65536, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002763 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2764 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2765 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2766 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2767
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002768tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2769 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2770 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2771 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2772 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2773 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002774 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002775 recommended not to change this value.
2776
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002777tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002778 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002779 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002780 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002781 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2782 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2783 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2784 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2785
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002786tune.http.cookielen <number>
2787 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2788 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2789 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2790 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2791 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2792 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2793 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2794 to change this value.
2795
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002796tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002797 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2798 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002799 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002800 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002801 configuration directives too.
2802 The default value is 1024.
2803
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002804tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2805 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2806 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2807 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2808 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2809 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2810 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002811 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2812 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2813 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002814
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002815tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2816 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2817 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2818 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2819 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2820 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2821 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002822 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2823 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2824 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2825 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2826 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002827
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002828tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002829 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002830 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2831 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2832 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2833 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002834 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002835 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002836 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002837 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2838
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002839tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2840 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2841 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2842 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2843 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2844 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2845 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2846 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2847 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2848 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2849
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002850tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2851 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002852 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002853 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2854 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002855 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002856 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2857 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2858
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002859tune.lua.maxmem
2860 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2861 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2862 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2863 memory.
2864
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002865tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2866 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002867 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2868 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002869 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002870
2871tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2872 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2873 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2874 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2875 check servers.
2876
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002877tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2878 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2879 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2880 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002881 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002882
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002883tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002884 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2885 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002886 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2887 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2888 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2889 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2890 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2891 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2892 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2893 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2894 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002895
2896tune.maxpollevents <number>
2897 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2898 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2899 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2900 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2901 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2902
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002903tune.maxrewrite <number>
2904 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2905 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2906 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2907 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2908 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2909 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2910 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2911 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2912 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2913 bufsize.
2914
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002915tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2916 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2917 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2918 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2919 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2920 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2921 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2922 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2923 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2924 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002925 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2926 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002927 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2928 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2929 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2930 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2931 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2932 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2933 setting this parameter to 0.
2934
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02002935tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
2936 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
2937 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
2938 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
2939 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
2940 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
2941 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
2942 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
2943
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002944tune.pipesize <number>
2945 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2946 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2947 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2948 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2949 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2950 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2951
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002952tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2953 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002954 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002955 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2956 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2957 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2958 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002959 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002960
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002961tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2962 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002963 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002964 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2965 default is 20.
2966
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02002967tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02002968 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2969 change without deprecation in the future.
2970
2971 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
2972 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
2973 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
2974 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02002975 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02002976
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02002977tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
2978 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2979 change without deprecation in the future.
2980
2981 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
2982 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
2983 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
2984 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
2985 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
2986 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
2987 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
2988
2989 The default value is 30000.
2990
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02002991tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
2992 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2993 change without deprecation in the future.
2994
2995 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
2996 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
2997 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
2998 requests.
2999
3000 The default value is 100.
3001
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003002tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
3003 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3004 change without deprecation in the future.
3005
3006 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003007 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3008 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003009 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3010 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003011 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3012 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003013
3014 The default value is 100.
3015
3016 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3017 information about QUIC retry.
3018
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003019tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3020tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3021 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3022 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3023 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003024 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003025 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003026 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3027 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3028
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003029tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003030 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003031 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3032 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3033 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3034 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3035
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003036tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003037 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003038 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3039 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3040 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3041 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3042 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3043 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3044 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003045
3046tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3047 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003048 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003049 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3050 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3051 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3052 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3053 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3054 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3055 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003056
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003057tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3058tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3059 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3060 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3061 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003062 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003063 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003064 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3065 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3066 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3067 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003068 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003069
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003070tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003071 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003072 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3073 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3074 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3075 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3076 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3077 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3078 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3079 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3080 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003081 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3082 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003083
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003084tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003085 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003086 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3087 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3088 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3089 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3090 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3091
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003092tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3093 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3094 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3095 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3096 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3097
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003098tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3099 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3100 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3101 performances. This is disabled by default.
3102
3103 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3104 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3105
3106 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3107
3108 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3109
3110 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3111
3112 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3113 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3114 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3115
3116 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3117 converted.
3118
3119 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3120 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3121 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3122 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3123 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3124 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3125 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003126 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3127 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003128
3129 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3130
3131 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3132 only need this line:
3133
3134 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3135
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003136tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3137 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003138 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003139 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3140 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3141 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3142 being used for too long.
3143
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003144tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003145 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3146 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3147 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3148 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3149 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3150 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3151 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3152 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3153 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3154 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3155 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3156 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3157 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003158
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02003159tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3160 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3161 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3162 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3163 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02003164 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3165 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3166 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3167 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3168 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3169 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3170 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3171 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02003172
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003173tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3174 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3175 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3176 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3177 1000 entries.
3178
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02003179tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3180tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02003181 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3182 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3183 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3184 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01003185
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003186tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003187tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003188tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3189tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3190tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003191 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3192 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3193 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3194 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3195 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3196 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3197 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3198 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003199
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003200 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3201 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3202 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3203 all available space is consumed.
3204 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3205 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3206 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003207
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003208tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3209 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003210 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003211 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003212 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003213 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3214
3215tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3216 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3217 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003218 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3219 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032213.3. Debugging
3222--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003223
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003224quiet
3225 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3226 line argument "-q".
3227
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003228zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003229 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003230 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3231 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3232 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3233 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3234 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3235
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010032373.4. Userlists
3238--------------
3239It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3240http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3241it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3242
3243userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003244 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003245 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3246
3247group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003248 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003249 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3250 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3251
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003252user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3253 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003254 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3255 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003256 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3257 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3258 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3259 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003260
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003261 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3262 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3263 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3264 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3265 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3266 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3267 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003268 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003269 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003270
3271 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003272 userlist L1
3273 group G1 users tiger,scott
3274 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003275
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003276 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3277 user scott insecure-password elgato
3278 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003279
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003280 userlist L2
3281 group G1
3282 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003283
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003284 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3285 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3286 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003287
3288 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003289
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003290
32913.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003292----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003293It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003294several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003295instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003296values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3297type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3298values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3299active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3300switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3301present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3302watch it.
3303
3304Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3305known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3306the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3307process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3308during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3309tables.
3310
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003311Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3312that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3313each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003314
3315peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003316 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003317 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3318
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003319bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3320 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3321 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3322
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003323disabled
3324 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3325 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3326 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3327
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003328default-bind [param*]
3329 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3330
3331default-server [param*]
3332 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3333
3334 Arguments:
3335 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3336 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003337 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3338 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3339 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3340 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003341
3342 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3343
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003344enabled
3345 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3346 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003347
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003348log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003349 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3350 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3351 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3352 more details.
3353
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003354peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003355 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3356 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003357 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003358 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003359 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3360 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3361 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003362
3363 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3364 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3365
3366 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003367 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3368 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3369 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003370
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003371 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3372 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003373
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003374 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3375 "server" keyword explanation below).
3376
3377server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003378 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003379 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3380 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3381 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3382 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003383
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003384 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3385 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3386 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3387 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3388 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003389
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003390 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003391 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003392 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003393 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3394 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3395 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003396
3397 backend mybackend
3398 mode tcp
3399 balance roundrobin
3400 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3401 stick on src
3402
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003403 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3404 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003405
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003406 Example:
3407 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003408 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3409 default-server ssl verify none
3410 server haproxy1 #local peer
3411 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3412 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003413
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003414
3415table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3416 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3417
3418 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3419 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003420 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003421 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3422 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3423 "stick-table" keyword).
3424
3425 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3426 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3427 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3428 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3429 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3430 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3431 of the stick-table name as follows:
3432
3433 peers mypeers
3434 peer A ...
3435 peer B ...
3436 table t1 ...
3437
3438 frontend fe1
3439 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3440
3441 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3442 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3443
3444 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3445 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3446 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3447 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3448 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3449 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3450 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3451
3452 peers mypeers
3453 peer A ...
3454 peer B ...
3455 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3456
3457 backend t1
3458 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3459
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003460 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003461 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3462 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3463
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090034643.6. Mailers
3465------------
3466It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3467If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3468in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3469
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003470mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003471 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3472 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3473
3474mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3475 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3476
3477 Example:
3478 mailers mymailers
3479 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3480 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3481
3482 backend mybackend
3483 mode tcp
3484 balance roundrobin
3485
3486 email-alert mailers mymailers
3487 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3488 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3489
3490 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3491 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3492
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003493timeout mail <time>
3494 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3495 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3496 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3497 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3498
3499 Example:
3500 mailers mymailers
3501 timeout mail 20s
3502 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003503
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020035043.7. Programs
3505-------------
3506In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3507master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3508managed the same way as the workers.
3509
3510During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3511sequence as a worker:
3512
3513 - the master is re-executed
3514 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3515 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3516 instance of the program
3517
3518During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3519
3520program <name>
3521 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3522 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3523 the management guide).
3524
3525command <command> [arguments*]
3526 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3527 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3528 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3529 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3530
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003531user <user name>
3532 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3533 See also "group".
3534
3535group <group name>
3536 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3537 See also "user".
3538
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003539option start-on-reload
3540no option start-on-reload
3541 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3542 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3543 program section.
3544
3545
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010035463.8. HTTP-errors
3547----------------
3548
3549It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3550imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3551several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3552
3553http-errors <name>
3554 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3555 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3556
3557errorfile <code> <file>
3558 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3559
3560 Arguments :
3561 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003562 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003563 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003564
3565 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3566 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3567 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3568 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3569 before any chroot is performed.
3570
3571 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3572
3573 Example:
3574 http-errors website-1
3575 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3576 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3577 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3578
3579 http-errors website-2
3580 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3581 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3582 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3583
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020035843.9. Rings
3585----------
3586
3587It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3588servers or traces.
3589
3590ring <ringname>
3591 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3592
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003593backing-file <path>
3594 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
3595 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
3596 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
3597 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
3598 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
3599 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
3600 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
3601
3602 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
3603 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
3604 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
3605 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreauded77cc2022-08-12 15:38:20 +02003606 by the "size" directive. Any previously existing file will be renamed with
3607 the extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak"
3608 will be removed. This ensures that instant restart of the process will not
3609 wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to spot
3610 this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. This means that the total
3611 storage capacity required will be double of the ring size.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003612
3613 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
3614 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
3615 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
3616 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
3617 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
3618 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
3619 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
3620
3621 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
3622 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
3623 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
3624
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003625description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003626 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003627 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3628
3629format <format>
3630 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3631
3632 Arguments:
3633 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3634 one of the following :
3635
3636 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3637 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3638 designed to be used with a local log server.
3639
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003640 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3641 field is stripped. This is the default.
3642 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3643 rfc3164.
3644
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003645 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3646 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3647 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3648 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3649 is the default.
3650
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003651 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003652 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3653
3654 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3655 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3656
3657 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3658 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3659 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3660 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3661 logger consumes.
3662
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003663 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3664 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3665 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3666 with a local log server.
3667
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003668 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3669 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3670 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3671 used with a local log server.
3672
3673maxlen <length>
3674 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3675 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3676 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3677
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003678server <name> <address> [param*]
3679 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3680 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3681 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3682 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3683 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3684 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3685 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3686 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3687 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003688 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3689 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003690
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003691size <size>
3692 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3693 set to BUFSIZE.
3694
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003695timeout connect <timeout>
3696 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3697
3698 Arguments :
3699 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3700 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3701 as explained at the top of this document.
3702
3703timeout server <timeout>
3704 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3705
3706 Arguments :
3707 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3708 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3709 as explained at the top of this document.
3710
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003711 Example:
3712 global
3713 log ring@myring local7
3714
3715 ring myring
3716 description "My local buffer"
3717 format rfc3164
3718 maxlen 1200
3719 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003720 timeout connect 5s
3721 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003722 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003723
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020037243.10. Log forwarding
3725-------------------
3726
3727It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003728HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003729
3730log-forward <name>
3731 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3732
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003733backlog <conns>
3734 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3735 on connections accept.
3736
3737bind <addr> [param*]
3738 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003739 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3740 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3741 syslog protocol over TCP.
3742 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003743 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3744
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003745dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003746 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3747 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3748 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3749 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003750 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003751
3752log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003753log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003754 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3755 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3756 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003757 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003758 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3759 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3760 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003761 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003762
3763 Example:
3764 global
3765 log stderr format iso local7
3766
3767 ring myring
3768 description "My local buffer"
3769 format rfc5424
3770 maxlen 1200
3771 size 32764
3772 timeout connect 5s
3773 timeout server 10s
3774 # syslog tcp server
3775 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3776
3777 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003778 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3779 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003780 # all messages on stderr
3781 log global
3782 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3783 log ring@myring local0
3784 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3785 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3786 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3787 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3788 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003789
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003790maxconn <conns>
3791 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3792 10 is the default.
3793
3794timeout client <timeout>
3795 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037974. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003798----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003799
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003800Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003801 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3802 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3803 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3804 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003805
3806A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3807connections.
3808
3809A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3810to forward incoming connections.
3811
3812A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3813parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3814
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003815A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3816ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3817sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3818the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3819explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3820from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3821"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3822for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3823to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3824optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3825are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3826any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3827names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3828that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3829duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003830names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3831is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3832implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
3833encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
3834adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003835
3836Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3837settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3838of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3839profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3840timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3841
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003842All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3843'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3844case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3845
3846Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3847logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3848proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3849However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3850name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3851
3852Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3853and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003854bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003855protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3856modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3857arbitrary criteria.
3858
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003859In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3860a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003861the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003862
3863 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3864 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3865 between responses and new requests.
3866
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003867 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3868 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3869 client-facing connection remains open.
3870
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003871 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3872 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003873
3874The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3875frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3876following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003877weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003878
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003879 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003880
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003881 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3882 ----+-----+-----+----
3883 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3884 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003885 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3886 ----+-----+-----+----
3887 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003888
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003889It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003890only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3891within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003892as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003893content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003894and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3895possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003896
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003897There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003898first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003899processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003900second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003901protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3902is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3903new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003904to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003905process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3906already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3907HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3908evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3909one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3910
3911There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3912performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3913tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3914preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3915analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3916HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3917header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3918mitigate this drawback.
3919
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003920There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003921method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3922set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3923in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3924is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3925to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3926above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3927to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3928"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3929frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3930frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3931as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3932upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3933on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3934the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3935upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3936frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3937remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020039394.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3940--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003942The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3943limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3944they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3945limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003946marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003947option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003948and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3949with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003950specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
3951sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
3952anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003953
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003954
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003955 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3956------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003957acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003958backlog X X X -
3959balance X - X X
3960bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003961capture cookie - X X -
3962capture request header - X X -
3963capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003964clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3965clitcpka-idle X X X -
3966clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003967compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003968cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003969declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003970default-server X - X X
3971default_backend X X X -
3972description - X X X
3973disabled X X X X
3974dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003975email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003976email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003977email-alert mailers X X X X
3978email-alert myhostname X X X X
3979email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003980enabled X X X X
3981errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003982errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003983errorloc X X X X
3984errorloc302 X X X X
3985-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3986errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003987error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003988force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003989filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003990fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003991hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003992http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003993http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003994http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003995http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003996http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003997http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003998http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003999http-check set-var X - X X
4000http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004001http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004002http-request X (!) X X X
4003http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004004http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02004005http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004006id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004007ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004008load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004009log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004010log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004011log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004012log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004013max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004014maxconn X X X -
4015mode X X X X
4016monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004017monitor-uri X X X -
4018option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4019option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4020option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4021option allbackups (*) X - X X
4022option checkcache (*) X - X X
4023option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4024option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004025option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004026option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4027option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004028-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4029option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004030option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4031option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004032option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004033option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004034option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004035option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004036option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004037option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004038option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4039option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4040option httpchk X - X X
4041option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004042option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004043option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004044option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004045option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004046option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004047option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4048option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4049option logasap (*) X X X -
4050option mysql-check X - X X
4051option nolinger (*) X X X X
4052option originalto X X X X
4053option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004054option pgsql-check X - X X
4055option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004056option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004057option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004058option smtpchk X - X X
4059option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4060option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4061option splice-request (*) X X X X
4062option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01004063option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004064option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4065option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4066-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004067option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004068option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4069option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4070option tcpka X X X X
4071option tcplog X X X X
4072option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004073option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004074external-check command X - X X
4075external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004076persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4077rate-limit sessions X X X -
4078redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004079-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004080retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004081retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004082server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004083server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004084server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004085source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004086srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4087srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4088srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004089stats admin - X X X
4090stats auth X X X X
4091stats enable X X X X
4092stats hide-version X X X X
4093stats http-request - X X X
4094stats realm X X X X
4095stats refresh X X X X
4096stats scope X X X X
4097stats show-desc X X X X
4098stats show-legends X X X X
4099stats show-node X X X X
4100stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004101-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4102stick match - - X X
4103stick on - - X X
4104stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004105stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004106stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004107tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004108tcp-check connect X - X X
4109tcp-check expect X - X X
4110tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004111tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004112tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004113tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004114tcp-check set-var X - X X
4115tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004116tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4117tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4118tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4119tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4120tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4121tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004122timeout check X - X X
4123timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004124timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004125timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004126timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4127timeout http-request X X X X
4128timeout queue X - X X
4129timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004130timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004131timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004132timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004133transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004134unique-id-format X X X -
4135unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004136use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004137use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004138use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004139------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4140 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004141
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020041434.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4144---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004145
4146This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4147
4148
4149acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4150 Declare or complete an access list.
4151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004152 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4153
4154 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4155 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4156 using it.
4157
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004158 Example:
4159 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4160 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4161 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004163 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004164
4165
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004166backlog <conns>
4167 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4169 yes | yes | yes | no
4170 Arguments :
4171 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4172 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004173 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004174
4175 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4176 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4177 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4178 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4179 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4180 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4181 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4182 backlog parameter.
4183
4184 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4185 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4186 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4187
4188 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4189
4190
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004191balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004192balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004193 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4195 yes | no | yes | yes
4196 Arguments :
4197 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4198 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4199 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4200 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4201
4202 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4203 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4204 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4205 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004206 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004207 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004208 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4209 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4210 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4211 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4212 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4213 it, so that you don't worry.
4214
4215 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4216 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4217 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4218 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4219 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4220 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4221 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4222 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004223
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004224 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4225 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4226 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4227 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4228 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4229 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4230 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004231 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4232 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4233 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004234
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004235 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004236 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004237 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4238 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004239 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004240 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4241 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4242 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4243 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4244 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004245 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4246 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4247 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4248 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4249 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4250 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004251
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004252 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4253 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4254 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4255 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4256 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4257 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4258 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4259 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4260 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4261 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4262 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4263 changed using "hash-type".
4264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004265 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4266 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4267 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4268 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4269 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4270 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4271 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4272 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004273 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004274 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004275 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4276 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004277 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004279 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4280 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4281 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4282 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4283 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4284 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4285 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4286 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4287 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4288 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4289 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4290 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004291
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004292 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004293 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4294 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4295 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4296 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4297 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4298 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4299 URIs start with a leading "/".
4300
4301 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4302 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4303 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4304 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4305
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004306 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4307 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4308 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004309 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4310 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004311
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004312 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004313 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4314
4315 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004316 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4317 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004318 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4319 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4320 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4321 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004322 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004323 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4324 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004325
4326 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4327 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4328 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4329 server will receive the request.
4330
4331 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4332 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4333 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4334 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4335 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004336 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4337 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004338 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4339 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004340
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004341 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4342 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4343 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4344 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4345 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004347 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004348 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4349 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4350 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4351
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004352 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4353 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004354 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4355 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004356
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004357 random
4358 random(<draws>)
4359 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004360 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4361 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4362 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4363 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004364 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4365 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4366 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4367 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4368 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4369 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4370 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4371 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4372 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4373 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4374 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4375 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4376 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4377 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4378 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4379 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4380 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4381 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4382 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4383 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004384
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004385 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004386 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004387 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4388 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004389 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004390 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4391 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4392 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004393 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004394 used instead.
4395
4396 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4397 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4398 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004399 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004400
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004401 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4402 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004403 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4404 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004405
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004406 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004407 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4408 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004409
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004410 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4411 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4412 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004413
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004414 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004415 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004416 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4417 NTLM relies on.
4418
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004419 Examples :
4420 balance roundrobin
4421 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004422 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004423 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4424 balance hdr(host)
4425 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004426 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4427 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4428 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004429
4430 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4431 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004433 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004434 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4435 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4436 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004437 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004438
4439 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4440 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4441 defaults to 16 kB.
4442
4443 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4444 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4445
4446 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4447 Round Robin.
4448
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004449 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004450 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4451 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4452 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4453
4454 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4455
4456 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004457 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004458 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4459 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4460 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004461
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004462 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463
4464
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004465bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4466bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004467 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4469 no | yes | yes | no
4470 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004471 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4472 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4473 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4474 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004475 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
4476 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
4477 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
4478 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
4479 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004480 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4481 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4482 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4483 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4484 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4485 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004486 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004487 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4488 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004489 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004490 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4491 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004492 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004493 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4494 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004495 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004496 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004497 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4498 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4499 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004500 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4501 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4502 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4503 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004504 - 'quicv4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol
4505 UDP is used.
4506 - 'quicv6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol
4507 UDP is used.
4508
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004509 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4510 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4511 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004512
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004513 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4514 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004515 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4516 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4517 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004518 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4519 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4520 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4521 the range.
4522
4523 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4524 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4525 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4526 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4527 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4528 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4529 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004530 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004531 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004532
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004533 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004534 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004535 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4536 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4537 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4538 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4539 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4540 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4541
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004542 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4543 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4544 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4545 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004546
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004547 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4548 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4549 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4550 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4551 in a frontend.
4552
4553 Example :
4554 listen http_proxy
4555 bind :80,:443
4556 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004557 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004558
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004559 listen http_https_proxy
4560 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004561 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004562
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004563 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4564 bind ipv6@:80
4565 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4566 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4567
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004568 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004569 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004570
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004571 listen h3_quic_proxy
4572 bind quic@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt alpn h3
4573
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004574 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4575 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4576 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4577 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4578 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4579
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004580 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004581 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004582
4583
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004584capture cookie <name> len <length>
4585 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4587 no | yes | yes | no
4588 Arguments :
4589 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4590 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4591 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4592 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004593 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004594
4595 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4596 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4597 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4598 right if it exceeds <length>.
4599
4600 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4601 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4602 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4603 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4604
4605 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4606 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4607 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4608
4609 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4610 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4611 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004612 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4613 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4614 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004615
4616 Example:
4617 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4618
4619 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004620 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004621
4622
4623capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004624 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4626 no | yes | yes | no
4627 Arguments :
4628 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004629 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004630 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4631 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4632 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4633
4634 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4635 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4636 it exceeds <length>.
4637
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004638 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004639 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4640 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004641 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4642 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4643 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4644 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004645 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004646 environments to find where the request came from.
4647
4648 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4649 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4650 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4651 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004652
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004653 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4654 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4655 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4656 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4657 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004658
4659 Example:
4660 capture request header Host len 15
4661 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004662 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004664 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004665 about logging.
4666
4667
4668capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004669 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4671 no | yes | yes | no
4672 Arguments :
4673 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004674 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004675 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4676 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4677 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4678
4679 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4680 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4681 it exceeds <length>.
4682
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004683 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004684 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4685 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4686 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004687 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4688 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4689 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4690 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004691
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004692 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4693 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4694 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4695 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4696 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004697
4698 Example:
4699 capture response header Content-length len 9
4700 capture response header Location len 15
4701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004702 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004703 about logging.
4704
4705
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004706clitcpka-cnt <count>
4707 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4708 the connection on the client side.
4709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4710 yes | yes | yes | no
4711 Arguments :
4712 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4713
4714 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4715 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004716 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4717 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004718
4719 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4720
4721
4722clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4723 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4724 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4725 client side.
4726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4727 yes | yes | yes | no
4728 Arguments :
4729 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4730 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4731 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4732 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4733
4734 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4735 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004736 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4737 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004738
4739 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4740
4741
4742clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4743 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4745 yes | yes | yes | no
4746 Arguments :
4747 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4748 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4749 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4750 document.
4751
4752 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4753 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004754 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4755 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004756
4757 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4758
4759
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004760compression algo <algorithm> ...
4761compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004762 Enable HTTP compression.
4763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 yes | yes | yes | yes
4765 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004766 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4767 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004768
4769 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004770 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4771 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4772 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004773
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004774 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004775 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004776
4777 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4778 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4779 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4780 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4781 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004782 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004783
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004784 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4785 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4786 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4787 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4788 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4789 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4790 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004791 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004792
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004793 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004794 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004795 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004796 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004797 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004798 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004799 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004800
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004801 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004802 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4803 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004804 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004805 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004806 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4807 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4808 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4809 "multipart"
4810 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4811 header
4812 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4813 and later
4814 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4815 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004816 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004817
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004818 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004819
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004820 Examples :
4821 compression algo gzip
4822 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004823
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004824 See also : "compression offload"
4825
4826compression offload
4827 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
4828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4829 no | yes | yes | yes
4830
4831 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4832 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4833 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4834 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4835 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
4836 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4837 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4838 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4839 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4840 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
4841 then be used for such scenarios.
4842
4843 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
4844 option is ignored.
4845
4846 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004847
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004848cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004849 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4850 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004851 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004852 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4854 yes | no | yes | yes
4855 Arguments :
4856 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4857 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4858 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4859 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4860 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4861 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004862 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004863 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4864 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4865
4866 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004867 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004868 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4869 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4870 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4871 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004872 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4873 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004874 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004875 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4876 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004877
4878 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004879 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004880
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004881 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004882 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004883 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004884 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004885 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4886 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4887 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4888 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4889 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4890 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4891 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004892
4893 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4894 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4895 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4896 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4897 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4898 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4899 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4900 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4901 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004902 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004903 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4904 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4905 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004906
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004907 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4908 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4909 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004910 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4911 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4912 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4913 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004914 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4915 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4916 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004917
4918 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4919 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4920 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4921 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4922 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4923 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4924 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4925 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4926 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4927
4928 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4929 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4930 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4931 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4932 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4933 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4934 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4935 persistence cookie in the cache.
4936 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4937
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004938 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4939 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004940 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004941 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4942 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004943 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004944 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4945 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4946 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4947 they logout.
4948
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004949 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004950 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4951 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4952 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4953
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004954 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004955 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4956 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4957 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4958 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4959 this attribute.
4960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004961 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004962 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004963 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4964 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4965 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4966 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4967 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4968 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004969
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004970 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4971 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4972 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4973 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4974 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4975 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4976 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4977 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004978 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004979 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4980 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4981 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4982 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4983 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4984 the site.
4985
4986 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4987 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4988 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4989 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4990 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4991 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4992 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4993 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4994 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4995 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4996 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4997 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4998 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004999 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005000 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5001 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5002
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005003 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5004 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5005 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5006 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5007 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5008 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5009
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005010 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005011 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5012 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5013 repeated.
5014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005015 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5016 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5017 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5018 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005019
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005020 Examples :
5021 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5022 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5023 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005024 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005025
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005026 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005027
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005028
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005029declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5030 Declares a capture slot.
5031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5032 no | yes | yes | no
5033 Arguments:
5034 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5035
5036 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5037 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5038 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5039 for use in the response.
5040
5041 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005042 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005043 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5044
5045
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005046default-server [param*]
5047 Change default options for a server in a backend
5048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5049 yes | no | yes | yes
5050 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005051 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5052 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5053 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5054 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005055
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005056 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005057 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5058
5059 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005060
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005061
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005062default_backend <backend>
5063 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5065 yes | yes | yes | no
5066 Arguments :
5067 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5068
5069 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5070 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5071 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5072 will catch all undetermined requests.
5073
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005074 Example :
5075
5076 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5077 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5078 default_backend dynamic
5079
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005080 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005082
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005083description <string>
5084 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5086 no | yes | yes | yes
5087 Arguments : string
5088
5089 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5090 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5091 it describes.
5092 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5093
5094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005095disabled
5096 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5098 yes | yes | yes | yes
5099 Arguments : none
5100
5101 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5102 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5103 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5104 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5105 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5106 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5107 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5108
5109 See also : "enabled"
5110
5111
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005112dispatch <address>:<port>
5113 Set a default server address
5114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5115 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005116 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005117
5118 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5119 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5120 during start-up.
5121
5122 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5123 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5124 possible with normal servers.
5125
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005126 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005127 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5128 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5129 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5130 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5131
5132 See also : "server"
5133
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005134
5135dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5136 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5138 yes | no | yes | yes
5139 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5140
5141 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005142 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005143 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5144 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005145 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005146 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005147
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005148enabled
5149 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5151 yes | yes | yes | yes
5152 Arguments : none
5153
5154 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5155 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5156
5157 See also : "disabled"
5158
5159
5160errorfile <code> <file>
5161 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5163 yes | yes | yes | yes
5164 Arguments :
5165 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005166 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005167 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005168
5169 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005170 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005171 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005172 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5173 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005174
5175 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5176 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5177 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5178
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005179 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5180
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005181 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5182 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5183 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5184 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5185 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5186 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5187 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5188 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5189 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005190
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005191 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5192 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5193 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005194 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005195 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5196
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005197 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005198
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005199 Example :
5200 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005201 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005202 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5203 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5204
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005205
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005206errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5207 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5208 section.
5209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5210 yes | yes | yes | yes
5211 Arguments :
5212 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5213
5214 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005215 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005216 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5217 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005218
5219 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5220 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5221 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5222 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5223 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005224 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005225 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5226
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005227 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5228 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005229
5230 Example :
5231 errorfiles generic
5232 errorfiles site-1 403 404
5233
5234
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005235errorloc <code> <url>
5236errorloc302 <code> <url>
5237 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5239 yes | yes | yes | yes
5240 Arguments :
5241 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005242 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005243 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005244
5245 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5246 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5247 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5248 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005249 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005250
5251 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5252 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5253 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5254
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005255 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5256
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005257 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5258 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5259 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5260 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005261 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005262 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5263 request.
5264
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005265 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005266
5267
5268errorloc303 <code> <url>
5269 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5271 yes | yes | yes | yes
5272 Arguments :
5273 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005274 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005275 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005276
5277 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5278 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5279 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5280 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005281 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005282
5283 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5284 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5285 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5286
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005287 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5288
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005289 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5290 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5291 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5292 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005293 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005294
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005295 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005296
5297
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005298email-alert from <emailaddr>
5299 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005300 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005301 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5302 yes | yes | yes | yes
5303
5304 Arguments :
5305
5306 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5307
5308 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5309 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5310
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005311 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005312 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5313 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005314
5315
5316email-alert level <level>
5317 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5318 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 yes | yes | yes | yes
5321
5322 Arguments :
5323
5324 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5325 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5326 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5327
5328 By default level is alert
5329
5330 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5331 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5332 for the proxy.
5333
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005334 Alerts are sent when :
5335
5336 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5337 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5338 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5339 is notice or lower
5340 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5341 and a health check status update occurs
5342
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005343 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5344 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005345 section 3.6 about mailers.
5346
5347
5348email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5349 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5350 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5351 yes | yes | yes | yes
5352
5353 Arguments :
5354
5355 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5356
5357 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5358 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5359
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005360 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5361 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005362
5363
5364email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5365 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5366 mailers.
5367 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5368 yes | yes | yes | yes
5369
5370 Arguments :
5371
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005372 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005373
5374 By default the systems hostname is used.
5375
5376 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5377 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5378 for the proxy.
5379
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005380 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5381 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005382
5383
5384email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005385 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005386 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5387 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5388 yes | yes | yes | yes
5389
5390 Arguments :
5391
5392 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5393
5394 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5395 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5396
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005397 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005398 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5399
5400
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005401error-log-format <string>
5402 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5404 yes | yes | yes | no
5405
5406 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5407 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5408 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5409 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005410 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5411
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005412 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5413 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5414 string in depth.
5415
5416 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5417 directives.
5418
5419
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005420force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5421 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5422 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005423 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005424
5425 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5426 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5427 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5428 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5429 marked down for maintenance operations.
5430
5431 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5432 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5433 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5434 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5435 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5436 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5437 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5438 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5439 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5440
5441 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5442 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5443 is used.
5444
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005445 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005446 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005447
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005448
5449filter <name> [param*]
5450 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5452 no | yes | yes | yes
5453 Arguments :
5454 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5455 referenced in section 9.
5456
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005457 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005458 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005459 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5460 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005461
5462 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5463 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5464
5465 Example:
5466 listen
5467 bind *:80
5468
5469 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5470 filter compression
5471 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5472
5473 compression algo gzip
5474 compression offload
5475
5476 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5477
5478 See also : section 9.
5479
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005480
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005481fullconn <conns>
5482 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5484 yes | no | yes | yes
5485 Arguments :
5486 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5487 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5488
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005489 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005490 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005491 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005492 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5493 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5494 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5495 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5496 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005497 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005498
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005499 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005500 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005501 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5502 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5503 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005505 Example :
5506 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5507 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5508 # connections.
5509 backend dynamic
5510 fullconn 10000
5511 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5512 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5513
5514 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5515
5516
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005517hash-balance-factor <factor>
5518 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5520 yes | no | no | yes
5521 Arguments :
5522 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5523 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005524 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005525
5526 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5527 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5528 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5529 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5530 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5531 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5532 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5533
5534 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5535 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5536 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5537 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5538 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5539
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005540 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5541 consistent hashing mechanism.
5542
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005543 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5544
5545
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005546hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005547 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5549 yes | no | yes | yes
5550 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005551 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5552 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005553
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005554 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5555 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5556 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5557 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5558 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5559 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5560 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5561 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5562 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5563 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005564
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005565 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5566 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5567 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5568 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5569 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5570 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5571 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5572 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5573 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5574 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5575 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5576 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5577 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005578 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5579 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005580
5581 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5582
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005583 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005584 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5585 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5586 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005587 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5588 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5589 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005590
5591 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5592 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005593 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5594 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5595 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5596 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005598 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005599 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5600 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5601 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5602 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5603 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5604 parameter.
5605
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005606 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5607 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5608 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5609 used on strings.
5610
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005611 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5612
5613 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5614 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5615 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5616 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5617 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5618 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5619 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5620 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5621 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5622 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5623 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5624 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005625
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005626 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5627 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5628 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005629
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005630 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005631
5632
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005633http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5634 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5635 ones).
5636
5637 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005638 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005639
5640 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5641 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5642 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5643 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5644 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5645 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5646
5647 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5648 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5649 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5650
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005651 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5652 supported:
5653 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5654 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005655 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005656 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
5657 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5658 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5659 - set-header <name> <fmt>
5660 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005661 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5662 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005663 - strict-mode { on | off }
5664 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5665
5666 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005667
5668 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5669 instance.
5670
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005671 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5672 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5673 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5674 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5675 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5676 a defaults section defining such rules.
5677
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005678 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5679 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5680 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5681
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005682 Example:
5683 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5684 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5685 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5686
5687http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5688
5689 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005690 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5691 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005692
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005693http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5694
5695 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5696 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5697 complete description.
5698
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005699http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5700
5701 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01005702 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005703
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005704http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005705
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005706 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5707 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005708
5709http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5710 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5711
5712 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5713
5714 Example:
5715 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5716
5717 # applied to:
5718 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5719
5720 # outputs:
5721 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5722
5723 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5724
5725http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5726 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5727
5728 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5729
5730 Example:
5731 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5732
5733 # applied to:
5734 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5735
5736 # outputs:
5737 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5738
5739http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5740
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005741 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5742 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5743 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5744 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005745
5746http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5747 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5748
5749 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05005750 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005751 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005752
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005753http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5754http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005755
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005756 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5757 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5758 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005759
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005760http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005761
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005762 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5763 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005764
5765http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5766
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005767 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5768 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005769
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005770
5771http-check comment <string>
5772 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5773 it fails.
5774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5775 yes | no | yes | yes
5776
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005777 Arguments :
5778 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5779 rule fails.
5780
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005781 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5782 user-friendly error reporting.
5783
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005784 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005785 "http-check expect".
5786
5787
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005788http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5789 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005790 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005791 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5793 yes | no | yes | yes
5794
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005795 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005796 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5797
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005798 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005799 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005800
5801 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5802 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5803 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5804 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5805
5806 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5807
5808 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5809
5810 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5811
5812 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5813
5814 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5815
5816 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5817 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5818 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5819 is used.
5820
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005821 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5822 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5823 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5824 haproxy -vv.
5825
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005826 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5827
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005828 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5829 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5830 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5831 different ports or with different servers.
5832
5833 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5834 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5835 the port with a "http-check connect".
5836
5837 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5838 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5839 do.
5840
5841 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5842 unset-var or comment rules.
5843
5844 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005845 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5846 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5847 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5848 option httpchk
5849
5850 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005851 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005852 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005853 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005854 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005855 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005856
5857 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5858
5859 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005860
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005861
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005862http-check disable-on-404
5863 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005865 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005866 Arguments : none
5867
5868 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5869 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5870 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5871 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5872 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5873 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5874 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5875 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005876 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5877 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005878 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5879 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5880 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005881
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005882 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005883
5884
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005885http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5887 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5888 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005889 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005891 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005892
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005893 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005894 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5895
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005896 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5897 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5898 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5899 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5900 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5901 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5902 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5903 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5904 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5905 result is always conclusive.
5906
5907 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5908 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5909 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005910 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5911 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005912 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5913 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005914 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5915 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5916 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005917
5918 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5919 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005920 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5921 supported :
5922 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5923 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005924 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5925 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5926 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5927 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5928 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005929
5930 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5931 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005932 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5933 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5934 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5935 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005936 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5937
5938 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5939 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5940 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5941 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5942
5943 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5944 informational message reported in logs if an error
5945 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5946 log-format string.
5947
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005948 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005949 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5950 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005951 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5952 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5953 details on the supported keywords.
5954
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005955 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5956 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5957 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5958 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005959
5960 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5961 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5962 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5963 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5964 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5965
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005966 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5967 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5968 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5969 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5970 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5971 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5972 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005973
5974 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005975 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005976 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5977 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5978 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5979 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5980
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005981 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5982 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005983 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5984 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5985 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5986 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5987 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5988 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5989 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5990 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005991 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5992 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5993 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5994 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5995 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5996 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5997 insensitive on the header names.
5998
5999 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6000 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6001 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6002 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6003 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6004 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006005
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006006 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006007 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006008 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6009 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6010 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6011 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6012 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006013 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006014 trace).
6015
6016 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006017 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006018 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6019 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6020 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6021 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6022 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006023 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006024
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006025 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6026 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6027 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6028 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6029 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6030 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6031
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006032 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006033 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006034 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6035 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6036 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6037 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6038 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6039 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6040
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006041 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6042 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6043 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6044 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6045 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006046
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006047 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6048 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6049
6050 Examples :
6051 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006052 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006053
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006054 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6055 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6056
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006057 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006058 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006059
6060 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006061 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006062
6063 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006064 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006065
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006066 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006067 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006068
6069
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006070http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006071 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6072 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006073 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6074 health checks.
6075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6076 yes | no | yes | yes
6077 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006078 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6079
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006080 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6081 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6082 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6083 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6084 to invent non-standard ones.
6085
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006086 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6087 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6088 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6089 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6090
6091 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6092 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6093 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6094 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006095
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006096 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006097 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006098 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006099 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6100 to add it.
6101
6102 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6103 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6104 to the log-format rules.
6105
6106 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6107 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6108 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006109
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006110 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6111 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6112 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6113 request.
6114
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006115 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6116 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6117 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006118 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6119 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6120 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6121 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006122 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006123
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006124 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006125 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6126 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006127
6128 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6129 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6130 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6131 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6132 configured request authority.
6133
6134 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6135 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006136
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006137 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006138
6139
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006140http-check send-state
6141 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6143 yes | no | yes | yes
6144 Arguments : none
6145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006146 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006147 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006148 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6149 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6150 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006151
6152 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6153 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6154 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6155 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6156 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006157 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6158 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6159 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6160
6161 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6162 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6163 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6164
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006165 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6166 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6167 checked in multiple backends.
6168
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006169 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006170 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6171
6172 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6173 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6174 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6175 one fails.
6176
6177 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6178 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6179 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6180
6181 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6182 server's queue.
6183
6184 Example of a header received by the application server :
6185 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6186 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6187
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006188 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6189 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006190
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006191
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006192http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6193http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006194 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006195 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6196 yes | no | yes | yes
6197
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006198 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006199 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6200 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6201 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6202 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6203 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6204 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6205 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6206 and '-'.
6207
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006208 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6209 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006210 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006211 conditions.
6212
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006213 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6214
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006215 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6216 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6217
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006218 Examples :
6219 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006220 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006221
6222
6223http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006224 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6226 yes | no | yes | yes
6227
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006228 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006229 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6230 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6231 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6232 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6233 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6234 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6235 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6236 and '-'.
6237
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006238 Examples :
6239 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006241
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006242http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6243 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6244 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6245 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6246 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6248 yes | yes | yes | yes
6249 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006250 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006251 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006252 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006253 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006254
6255 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6256 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6257 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6258 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6259
6260 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6261 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6262 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6263 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6264
6265 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6266 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6267 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6268 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6269 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6270 chroot is performed.
6271
6272 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6273 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6274 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6275 considered.
6276
6277 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6278 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6279 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6280 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6281 considered as a raw string.
6282
6283 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6284 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6285 "content-type".
6286
6287 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6288 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6289 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6290 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6291 evaluated as a log-format string.
6292
6293 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6294 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6295 argument to "content-type".
6296
6297 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6298 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6299 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6300 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6301
6302 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6303 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6304 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6305 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6306 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6307 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6308 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6309 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6310
6311 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6312 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6313 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6314
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006315 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6316 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6317 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6318 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6319 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6320
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006321 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6322 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6323
6324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006325http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006326 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6327
6328 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006329 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006330
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006331 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6332 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6333 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6334 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6335 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006336
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006337 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6338 supported:
6339 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6340 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6341 - allow
6342 - auth [realm <realm>]
6343 - cache-use <name>
6344 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6345 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6346 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6347 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6348 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6349 - disable-l7-retry
6350 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6351 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6352 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6353 - redirect <rule>
6354 - reject
6355 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6356 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6357 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6358 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6359 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6360 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6361 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6362 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6363 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6364 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6365 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02006366 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006367 - set-dst <expr>
6368 - set-dst-port <expr>
6369 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6370 - set-log-level <level>
6371 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6372 - set-mark <mark>
6373 - set-method <fmt>
6374 - set-nice <nice>
6375 - set-path <fmt>
6376 - set-pathq <fmt>
6377 - set-priority-class <expr>
6378 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6379 - set-query <fmt>
6380 - set-src <expr>
6381 - set-src-port <expr>
6382 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6383 - set-tos <tos>
6384 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006385 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6386 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006387 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6388 - silent-drop
6389 - strict-mode { on | off }
6390 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6391 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6392 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6393 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6394 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6395 - use-service <service-name>
6396 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6397 - wait-for-handshake
6398 - cache-use <name>
6399
6400 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006402 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006403
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006404 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6405 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6406 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6407 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6408 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6409 a defaults section defining such rules.
6410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006411 Example:
6412 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6413 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6414 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006416 http-request allow if nagios
6417 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6418 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6419 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006421 Example:
6422 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6423 acl add path /addacl
6424 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006426 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006428 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6429 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006431 Example:
6432 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6433 acl setmap path /setmap
6434 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006436 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006438 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6439 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006440
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006441 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6442 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006444http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006446 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6447 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6448 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6449 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6450 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6451 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6452 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6453 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006455http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006457 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6458 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6459 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6460 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6461 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6462 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6463 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6464 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006465
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006466http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006467
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006468 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006469 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006470
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006471http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006472
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006473 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6474 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6475 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6476 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6477 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006478
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006479 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6480 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6481 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6482 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6483 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6484 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6485 instead.
6486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006487 Example:
6488 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6489 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006490
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006491http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006492
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006493 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006495http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6496 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006498 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6499 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6500 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6501 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6502 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6503 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6504 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6505 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6506 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006508 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6509 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6510 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006511 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6512
6513 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6514 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6515 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6516 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006518http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006520 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6521 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6522 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6523 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6524 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6525 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006526
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006527http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006528
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006529 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6530 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6531 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6532 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6533 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006535http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006537 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6538 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6539 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6540 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6541 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6542 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006543
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006544http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6545http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6546 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6547 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6548 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6549 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006550
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006551 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6552 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6553 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006554 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006555 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6556 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6557 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006558 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006559 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006560
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006561http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6562 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6563 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6564 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6565
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006566http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6567 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006568
6569 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6570 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6571 pointed by <resolvers>.
6572 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6573 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6574 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6575 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6576 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6577 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6578 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6579 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6580 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6581 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6582 to 0.0.0.0.
6583
6584 Example:
6585 resolvers mydns
6586 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6587 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6588 timeout retry 1s
6589 hold valid 10s
6590 hold nx 3s
6591 hold other 3s
6592 hold obsolete 0s
6593 accepted_payload_size 8192
6594
6595 frontend fe
6596 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6597 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6598 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6599
6600 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6601 # which mean DNS resolution error
6602 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6603
6604 default_backend be
6605
6606 backend b_503
6607 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6608 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6609 # 503 error page to end users
6610
6611 backend be
6612 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6613 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6614 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6615 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6616 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6617
6618 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6619 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6620
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006621http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6622
6623 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6624 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6625 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6626 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006627 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6628 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006629
6630 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6631
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006632http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006633http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006634http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006635http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006636http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006637http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006638http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006639http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6640http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006641
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006642 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6643
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006644 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006645 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6646 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6647 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6648 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006649
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006650 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6651 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6652 the supported backend.
6653
6654 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6655 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6656 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6657 number of segments in the path.
6658
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006659 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6660 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6661 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6662 when improperly combined.
6663
6664 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6665 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6666 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6667 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6668 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6669
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006670 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006671
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006672 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6673
6674 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6675 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6676
6677 Example:
6678 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6679
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006680 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6681
6682 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6683 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6684
6685 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6686 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6687
6688 Example:
6689 - /#foo -> /
6690
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006691 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6692 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006693
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006694 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6695 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6696
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006697 Example:
6698 - /. -> /
6699 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6700 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6701 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006702
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006703 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6704 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6705
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006706 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006707 their preceding segment.
6708
6709 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6710 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6711
6712 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6713 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006714
6715 Example:
6716 - /foo/../ -> /
6717 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6718 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6719 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006720 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006721 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006722 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006723
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006724 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6725 removed as well:
6726
6727 Example:
6728 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6729 - /bar/../../ -> /
6730
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006731 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6732 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006733
6734 Example:
6735 - // -> /
6736 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6737
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006738 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6739 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6740
6741 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6742 ".", "_", and "~".
6743
6744 Example:
6745 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6746 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6747 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6748 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6749
6750 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6751 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6752
6753 Example:
6754 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6755 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6756
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006757 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006758 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006759
6760 Example:
6761 - /%6f -> /%6F
6762 - /%zz -> /%zz
6763
6764 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6765 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6766
6767 Example:
6768 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6769
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006770 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006771 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6772 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6773
6774 Example:
6775 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6776 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6777 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6778
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006779http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006781 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6782 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6783 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6784 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6785 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006786
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006787http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006788
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006789 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6790 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6791 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6792 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006794http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6795 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006796
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006797 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006798 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6799 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6800 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6801 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6802 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006803
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006804 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6805 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6806 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6807 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6808 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006809
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006810 Example:
6811 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6812
6813 # applied to:
6814 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6815
6816 # outputs:
6817 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6818
6819 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006820
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006821 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6822
6823 # applied to:
6824 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006825
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006826 # outputs:
6827 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006828
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006829http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6830 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6831
6832 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6833 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006834 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6835 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6836 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006837
6838 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6839 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6840 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6841
6842 Example:
6843 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6844 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6845
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006846 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6847 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6848 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6849 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6850
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006851http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6852 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6853
6854 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6855 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6856 query-string are replaced.
6857
6858 Example:
6859 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6860 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6861
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006862http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6863 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6864
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006865 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6866 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6867 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6868 against.
6869
6870 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6871 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6872 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006873
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006874 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6875 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6876 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6877 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6878 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6879 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6880 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6881 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6882 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006883 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6884 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006885
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006886 Example:
6887 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6888 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006889
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006890 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6891 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006893http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6894 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006895
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006896 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6897 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6898 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6899 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006900
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006901 Example:
6902 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006903
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006904 # applied to:
6905 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006906
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006907 # outputs:
6908 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006909
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006910http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6911 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6912 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006913 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006914 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6915
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006916 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006917 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6918 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006919 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006920 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006921 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006922 are followed to create the response :
6923
6924 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6925 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6926 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6927 ignored.
6928
6929 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6930 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006931 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006932 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6933 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006934
6935 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6936 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6937 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006938 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006939 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006940
6941 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6942 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6943 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006944 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006945 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006946 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006947
6948 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6949 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6950 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6951 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6952 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6953 as a raw content.
6954
6955 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6956 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6957 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6958 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6959 considered as a raw string.
6960
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006961 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006962 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6963 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6964 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6965
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006966 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6967 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006968 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006969
6970 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6971
6972 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006973 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006974 if { path /ping }
6975
6976 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6977 if { path /favicon.ico }
6978
6979 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6980 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6981 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6982
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006983http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6984
6985 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6986 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6987 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6988 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6989 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6990 at this index.
6991 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6992 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006994http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6995http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006997 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6998 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6999 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007000
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007001http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7002 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7003 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7004 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7005 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7006 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7007 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7008 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7009 at this index.
7010 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7011 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7012
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007013http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7014 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007015
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007016 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7017 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7018 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7019 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007020
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007021http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7022 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7023
7024 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7025 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7026 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7027 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7028 agent name must be used.
7029
7030 Arguments:
7031 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7032
7033 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7034 configuration.
7035
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007036http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7037
7038 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7039 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7040 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7041 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7042 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7043 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7044 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7045 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7046
7047 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7048 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7049 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7050
7051 Arguments:
7052 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7053 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7054 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7055 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7056
7057 Example:
7058 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7059 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7060
7061 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007063http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007065 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7066 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7067 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7068 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7069 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007071 Arguments:
7072 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7073 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007075 Example:
7076 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7077 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007079 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7080 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007082http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007084 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7085 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7086 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007088 Arguments:
7089 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7090 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007092 Example:
7093 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7094 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007096 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7097 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7098 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007100http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007102 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7103 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7104 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7105 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7106 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007108 Example:
7109 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7110 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7111 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7112 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7113 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7114 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7115 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7116 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7117 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007119http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007121 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7122 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7123 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7124 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7125 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007127http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7128 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007130 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7131 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7132 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7133 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7134 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7135 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7136 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7137 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7138 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007139
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007140http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007141
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007142 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7143 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7144 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7145 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7146 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7147 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7148 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007149 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7150 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007152http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007154 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7155 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7156 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007158http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007160 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7161 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7162 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7163 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7164 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7165 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7166 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7167 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007169http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007171 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7172 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7173 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7174 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7175 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7176 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007178 Example :
7179 # prepend the host name before the path
7180 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007181
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007182http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7183
7184 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7185 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7186 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007188http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007190 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7191 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7192 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7193 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7194 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007196http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007198 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7199 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7200 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7201 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7202 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7203 values have higher priority.
7204 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7205 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7206 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7207 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7208 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007210http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007212 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7213 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7214 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7215 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7216 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7217 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7218 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007220 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007221
7222 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007223 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7224 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007226http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7227 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7228 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7229 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007230 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7231 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007232
7233 Arguments :
7234 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7235 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007236
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007237 See also "option forwardfor".
7238
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007239 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007240 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7241 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7242
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007243 # After the masking this will track connections
7244 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7245 http-request track-sc0 src
7246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007247 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7248 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7249
7250http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7251
7252 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7253 expression.
7254
7255 Arguments:
7256 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7257 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007258
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007259 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007260 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7261 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7262
7263 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7264 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7265 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7266
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007267http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007268 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7269
7270 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7271 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7272 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7273 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7274 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7275
7276 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7277 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7278 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7279 results.
7280
7281 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007282 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7283 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007285http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7286
7287 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7288 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7289 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7290 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7291 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7292 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7293 information from the request.
7294
7295 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7296
7297http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7298
7299 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7300 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
7301 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
7302 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
7303 path and the query string.
7304 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7305
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007306http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7307http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007308
7309 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7310 inline.
7311
7312 Arguments:
7313 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7314 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7315 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7316 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7317 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7318 (request and response)
7319 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7320 processing
7321 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7322 processing
7323 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7324 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7325 and '_'.
7326
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007327 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7328 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007329 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007330 conditions.
7331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007332 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7333 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007334
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007335 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7336 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7337
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007338 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007339 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007340 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007342http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7343
7344 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7345 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7346 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7347 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7348 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7349 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7350 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7351 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7352 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7353 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7354 action.
7355 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7356 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7357 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7358 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7359 you fully understand how it works.
7360
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007361http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007362
7363 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7364 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7365 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7366 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7367 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007368 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007369 processing.
7370
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007371 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007372 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7373 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7374 rules evaluation.
7375
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007376http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7377http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7378 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7379 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7380 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7381 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007382
7383 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7384 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7385 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007386 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7387 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7388 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7389 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7390 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7391 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007392 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007393 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7394 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7395 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007396 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007397 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7398 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7399 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7400 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7401 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007402
7403http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7404http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7405http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7406
7407 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7408 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
7409 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
7410 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02007411 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007412 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7413 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7414 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7415 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7416 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7417 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7418 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7419
7420 Arguments :
7421 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7422 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7423 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7424 select which table entry to update the counters.
7425
7426 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7427 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7428 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7429 that table until the session ends.
7430
7431 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7432 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7433 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7434 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7435 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7436 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7437 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7438 useful information.
7439
7440 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7441 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7442 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7443 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7444 checks that make use of it.
7445
7446http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7447
7448 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007449
7450 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007451 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007452
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007453http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7454
7455 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7456 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7457 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7458 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7459 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7460 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7461
7462 Arguments :
7463 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7464
7465 Example:
7466 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7467
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007468http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7469 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7470
7471 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7472 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7473 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7474 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7475 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7476 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7477 http-buffer-request".
7478
7479 Arguments :
7480
7481 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7482 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7483
7484 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007485 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007486 bytes.
7487
7488 Example:
7489 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7490
7491 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007493http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007495 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7496 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7497 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007498
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007499
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007500http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007501 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7502
7503 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007504 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007505
7506 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7507 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7508 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7509 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7510 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7511 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7512
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007513 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7514 supported:
7515 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7516 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7517 - allow
7518 - cache-store <name>
7519 - capture <sample> id <id>
7520 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7521 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7522 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7523 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7524 - redirect <rule>
7525 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7526 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7527 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7528 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7529 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7530 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7531 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7532 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7533 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007534 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007535 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7536 - set-log-level <level>
7537 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7538 - set-mark <mark>
7539 - set-nice <nice>
7540 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7541 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007542 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7543 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007544 - silent-drop
7545 - strict-mode { on | off }
7546 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7547 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7548 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7549 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7550 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7551
7552 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007553
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007554 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007555
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007556 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7557 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7558 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7559 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7560 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7561 a defaults section defining such rules.
7562
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007563 Example:
7564 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007565
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007566 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007567
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007568 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7569 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007570
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007571 Example:
7572 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007573
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007574 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007575
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007576 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7577 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007578
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007579 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7580 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007581
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007582http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007583
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007584 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7585 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007586
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007587http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007588
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007589 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007590 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7591 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007592
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007593http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007594
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007595 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7596 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007597
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007598http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007599
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007600 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007601
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007602http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007603
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007604 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7605 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7606 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7607 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7608 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7609 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7610 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007611
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007612 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7613 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7614 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7615 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7616 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007617
7618 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7619 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7620 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7621 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007622
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007623http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007624
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007625 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7626 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007627
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007628http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007629
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007630 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7631 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007632
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007633http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007634
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007635 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7636 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007637
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007638http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7639http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7640 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7641 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7642 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7643 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007644
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007645 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7646 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7647 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007648 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007649 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7650 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7651 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007652 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007653 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007654
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007655http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007657 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7658 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7659 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7660 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7661 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7662 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007664http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7665 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007666
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007667 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7668 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007669
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007670 Example:
7671 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007672
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007673 # applied to:
7674 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007675
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007676 # outputs:
7677 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007678
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007679 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007680
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007681http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7682 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007683
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007684 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007685 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007686
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007687 Example:
7688 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007690 # applied to:
7691 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007693 # outputs:
7694 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007695
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007696http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7697 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7698 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007699 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007700 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7701
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007702 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7703 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7704 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007705
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007706http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007707http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7708http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007709
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007710 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7711 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7712 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7713 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007714
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007715http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007716 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007717http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7718 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007719http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7720 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007721
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007722 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7723 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7724 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007725
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007726http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7727 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007728
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007729 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7730 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007731
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007732http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7733
7734 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7735 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
7736 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
7737
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007738http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007739
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007740 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7741 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7742 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7743 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007744
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007745http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7746
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007747 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7748 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007749
7750http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7751
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007752 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7753 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007754
7755http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7756
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007757 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
7758 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
7759 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007760
7761http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7762
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007763 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
7764 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007765
7766http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7767 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7768
7769 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7770 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7771 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7772 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007773
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007774 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007775 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7776 http-response set-status 431
7777 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7778 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007780http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007781
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007782 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007783 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
7784 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007785
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007786http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7787http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007788
7789 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007790 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
7791 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007792
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007793http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007795 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7796 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007797 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
7798 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007799
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007800http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007801
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007802 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
7803 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007804
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007805http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7806http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7807http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007808
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007809 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
7810 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
7811 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007812
7813http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7814
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007815 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007816 about <var-name>.
7817
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007818http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7819 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7820
7821 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007822 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
7823 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007824
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007825
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007826http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7827 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7828
7829 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7830 yes | no | yes | yes
7831
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007832 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007833 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7834 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7835 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007836
7837 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7838
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007839 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7840 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7841 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7842 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7843 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7844 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7845 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007846 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007847 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7848 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007849
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007850 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7851 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7852 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7853 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7854 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7855 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7856 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007857 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7858 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7859 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7860 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7861 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7862 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007863
7864 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7865 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7866 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7867 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7868 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7869 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7870 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7871 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007872 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007873 downsides of rare connection failures.
7874
7875 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7876 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7877 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7878 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7879 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7880 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007881 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007882 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7883 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7884 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7885 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7886 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7887
7888 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007889 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7890 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7891 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7892 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007893
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007894 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7895 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007896
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007897 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007898
7899 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7900 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7901 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7902
7903 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7904
7905
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007906http-send-name-header [<header>]
7907 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7909 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007910 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007911 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7912
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007913 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7914 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7915 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7916 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7917 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7918 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7919 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7920 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7921 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7922 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7923 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7924 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7925 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7926 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7927 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7928 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007929
7930 See also : "server"
7931
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007932id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007933 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 no | yes | yes | yes
7936 Arguments : none
7937
7938 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7939 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7940 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007941
7942
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007943ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7944 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007946 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007947
7948 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7949 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7950 and running).
7951
7952 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7953 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7954 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007955 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007956 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7957
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007958 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7959 "unless" condition is met.
7960
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007961 Example:
7962 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7963 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7964 ignore-persist if url_static
7965
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007966 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7967
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007968load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7969 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7970 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7971 yes | no | yes | yes
7972
7973 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7974 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7975 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007976 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007977 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007978 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7979 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7980 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7981
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007982 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007983 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007984 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007985
7986 Arguments:
7987 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7988 named "server-state-file".
7989
7990 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7991 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7992 name is used as a file name.
7993
7994 none don't load any stat for this backend
7995
7996 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007997 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7998 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7999 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008000 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008001 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008002
8003 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8004 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8005
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008006 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008007
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008008 global
8009 stats socket /tmp/socket
8010 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008011
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008012 defaults
8013 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008014
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008015 backend bk
8016 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8017 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008018
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008019
8020 Then one can run :
8021
8022 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8023
8024 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8025
8026 1
8027 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8028 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8029 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8030
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008031 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008032
8033 global
8034 stats socket /tmp/socket
8035 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8036
8037 defaults
8038 load-server-state-from-file local
8039
8040 backend bk
8041 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8042 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8043
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008044
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008045 Then one can run :
8046
8047 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8048
8049 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8050
8051 1
8052 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8053 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8054 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8055
8056 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8057 "show servers state"
8058
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008059
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008060log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008061log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008062 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008063no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008064 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8066 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008067
8068 Prefix :
8069 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8070 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8071 prefix does not allow arguments.
8072
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008073 Arguments :
8074 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8075 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8076 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8077 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8078 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8079 parameter.
8080
8081 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8082 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8083
8084 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8085 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8086 standard syslog port).
8087
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008088 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8089 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8090 standard syslog port).
8091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008092 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8093 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8094 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008095 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008096
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008097 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8098 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8099 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8100 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8101 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8102 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8103 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8104 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8105 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8106 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8107 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8108 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008109 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008110 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8111 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8112 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008113 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8114 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008115
8116 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8117 and "fd@2", see above.
8118
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008119 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8120 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8121 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8122 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8123 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8124 having the logs instantly available.
8125
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008126 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8127 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8128 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8129
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008130 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8131 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008132
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008133 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8134 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8135 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8136 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8137 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8138 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8139 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8140 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8141 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8142 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008143 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008144
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008145 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8146 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8147 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8148 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8149 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8150
8151 <sample_size>
8152 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8153 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8154 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8155 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8156 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8157
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008158 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8159 one of the following :
8160
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008161 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8162 field is stripped. This is the default.
8163 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8164 rfc3164.
8165
8166 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008167 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8168
8169 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8170 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8171
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008172 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8173 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8174 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8175 designed to be used with a local log server.
8176
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008177 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8178 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8179 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8180 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8181 systemd logger consumes.
8182
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008183 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8184 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8185 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8186 used with a local log server.
8187
8188 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8189 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8190 designed to be used with a local log server.
8191
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008192 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8193 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8194 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8195 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8196
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008197 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8198
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008199 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8200 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8201 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8202
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008203 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8204 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8205 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8206 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008207
8208 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8209 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8210 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008211 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8212 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8213 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8214 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8215 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008216
8217 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8218
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008219 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8220 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8221 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008222
8223 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8224 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8225 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8226 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8227
8228 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8229 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008230
8231 Example :
8232 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008233 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8234 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8235 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008236 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008237 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8238 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008239 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008240
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008241
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008242log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008243 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8244 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8245 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008246
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008247 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8248 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8249 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8250 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8251 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008252 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8253 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008254
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008255 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8256 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008257
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008258log-format-sd <string>
8259 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8260 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8261 yes | yes | yes | no
8262
8263 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8264 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8265 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8266 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8267 which covers the log format string in depth.
8268
8269 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8270 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8271
8272 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8273 log format to "rfc5424".
8274
8275 Example :
8276 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8277
8278
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008279log-tag <string>
8280 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8281 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8282 yes | yes | yes | yes
8283
8284 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8285 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008286 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008287 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8288 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8289 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8290 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8291 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8292 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008293
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008294max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8295 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8297 yes | no | yes | yes
8298
8299 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8300 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8301 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8302 servers.
8303
8304 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008305 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008306 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8307 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8308 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008309 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008310 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8311 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8312 picking a different server.
8313
8314 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8315 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8316 even if they have to be queued.
8317
8318 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8319 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8320
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008321max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8322 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8323 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8324 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008325
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008326maxconn <conns>
8327 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8329 yes | yes | yes | no
8330 Arguments :
8331 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8332 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8333 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8334 closes.
8335
8336 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008337 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008338 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8339 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008340 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8341 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8342 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8343 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008344
8345 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8346 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8347 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8348
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008349 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8350 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008351
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008352 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8353
8354
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008355mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008356 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8358 yes | yes | yes | yes
8359 Arguments :
8360 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8361 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8362 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8363 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8364
8365 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8366 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8367 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8368 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8369 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8370
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008371 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8372 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8373 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008374
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008375 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008376 defaults http_instances
8377 mode http
8378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008379
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008380monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008381 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8383 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008384 Arguments :
8385 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8386 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008387 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008388 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8389 backend and its backup.
8390
8391 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8392 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8393 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8394 servers in a list of backends.
8395
8396 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8397 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8398 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008399 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008400 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8401 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008402 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008403 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8404 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008405
8406 Example:
8407 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008408 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008409 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8410 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8411 monitor-uri /site_alive
8412 monitor fail if site_dead
8413
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008414 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008415
8416
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008417monitor-uri <uri>
8418 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8420 yes | yes | yes | no
8421 Arguments :
8422 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8423 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8424
8425 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8426 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8427 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8428 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8429 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8430 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8431 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8432 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8433
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008434 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008435 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8436 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8437 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8438 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8439 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8440 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008441
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008442 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8443 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8444 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8445 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8446
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008447 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008448 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008449 frontend www
8450 mode http
8451 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8452
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008453 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008455
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008456option abortonclose
8457no option abortonclose
8458 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8460 yes | no | yes | yes
8461 Arguments : none
8462
8463 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8464 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8465 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8466 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008467 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008468 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8469 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8470 encountered while delivering the response.
8471
8472 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8473 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8474 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8475 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8476 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8477 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008478 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008479 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008480 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008481 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8482 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8483 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8484
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008485 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8486 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008487 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8488 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8489 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8490 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8491 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8492 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008493 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008494
8495 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8496 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8497
8498 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8499
8500
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008501option accept-invalid-http-request
8502no option accept-invalid-http-request
8503 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8505 yes | yes | yes | no
8506 Arguments : none
8507
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008508 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008509 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008510 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008511 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8512 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8513 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8514 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8515 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008516 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8517 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8518 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8519 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008520 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008521 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008522 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02008523 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
8524 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008525
8526 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8527 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8528 been confirmed.
8529
8530 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8531 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008532 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8533 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008534 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8535
8536 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8537 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8538
8539 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8540 stats socket.
8541
8542
8543option accept-invalid-http-response
8544no option accept-invalid-http-response
8545 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8547 yes | no | yes | yes
8548 Arguments : none
8549
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008550 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008551 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008552 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008553 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8554 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8555 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8556 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8557 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008558 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8559 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8560 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008561
8562 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8563 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8564 been confirmed.
8565
8566 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8567 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8568 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8569 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8570
8571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8573
8574 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8575 stats socket.
8576
8577
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008578option allbackups
8579no option allbackups
8580 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8582 yes | no | yes | yes
8583 Arguments : none
8584
8585 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8586 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8587 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8588 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8589 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8590 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8591 order between the backup servers anymore.
8592
8593 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8594 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8595
8596 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8597 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8598
8599
8600option checkcache
8601no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008602 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8604 yes | no | yes | yes
8605 Arguments : none
8606
8607 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8608 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008609 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008610 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8611 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008612 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008613
8614 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008615 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008616 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008617 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8618 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008619 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008620 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008621 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8622 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008623 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008624 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8625 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008626 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008627 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8628 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8629 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8630 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8631 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8632 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8633 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8634 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8635 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8636
8637 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008638 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8639 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8640 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8641 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008642
8643 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8644 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008645 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008646 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008647
8648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8650
8651
8652option clitcpka
8653no option clitcpka
8654 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8656 yes | yes | yes | no
8657 Arguments : none
8658
8659 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8660 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008661 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008662 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8663
8664 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8665 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8666 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8667 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8668
8669 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8670 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8671 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8672 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8673 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8674
8675 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8676
8677 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8678 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8679 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8680
8681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8683
8684 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8685
8686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008687option contstats
8688 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8690 yes | yes | yes | no
8691 Arguments : none
8692
8693 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8694 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8695 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008696 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008697 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8698 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8699 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8700 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8701 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008702
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008703option disable-h2-upgrade
8704no option disable-h2-upgrade
8705 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8706 connection.
8707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8708 yes | yes | yes | no
8709 Arguments : none
8710
8711 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8712 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8713 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8714 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008715 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8716 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8717 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8718 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8719 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8720 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008721
8722 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8723 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008724
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008725option dontlog-normal
8726no option dontlog-normal
8727 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8729 yes | yes | yes | no
8730 Arguments : none
8731
8732 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8733 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8734 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8735 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8736 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8737 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8738 logged.
8739
8740 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8741 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8742 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008744 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008745 logging.
8746
8747
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008748option dontlognull
8749no option dontlognull
8750 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8752 yes | yes | yes | no
8753 Arguments : none
8754
8755 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8756 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8757 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8758 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8759 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8760 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008761 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8762 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8763 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008764
8765 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008766 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008767 would not be logged.
8768
8769 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8770 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8771
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008772 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008773 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008774
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008775
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008776option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008777 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8779 yes | yes | yes | yes
8780 Arguments :
8781 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8782 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008783 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008784 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008785
8786 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8787 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8788 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8789 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8790 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8791 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8792 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008793 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8794 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8795 possible that the client has already brought one.
8796
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008797 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008798 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008799 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008800 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008801 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008802 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008803
8804 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8805 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8806 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8807 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8808 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8809 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008810 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008811
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008812 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8813 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008814 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008815 are under the control of the end-user.
8816
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008817 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008818 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8819 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008820 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8821 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8822 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008823
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008824 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008825 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8826 frontend www
8827 mode http
8828 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8829
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008830 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8831 backend www
8832 mode http
8833 option forwardfor header X-Client
8834
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008835 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008836 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008837
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008838
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008839option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8840no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8841 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8843 yes | yes | yes | no
8844 Arguments : none
8845
8846 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8847 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8848 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8849 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8850 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8851 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8852 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8853
8854 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8855 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8856 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8857 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8858 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8859 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8860 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8861 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8862 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8863 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8864
8865 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8866
8867 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8868 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8869
8870 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8871 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8872
8873
8874option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8875no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8876 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8878 yes | no | yes | yes
8879 Arguments : none
8880
8881 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8882 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8883 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8884 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8885 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8886 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8887 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8888
8889 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8890 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8891 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8892 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8893 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8894 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8895 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8896 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8897 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8898 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8899
8900 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8901
8902 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8903 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8904
8905 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8906 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8907
8908
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008909option http-buffer-request
8910no option http-buffer-request
8911 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8913 yes | yes | yes | yes
8914 Arguments : none
8915
8916 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8917 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8918 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8919 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8920 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8921 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008922 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8923 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8924 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8925 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008926
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008927 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8928 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008929
8930
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008931option http-ignore-probes
8932no option http-ignore-probes
8933 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8935 yes | yes | yes | no
8936 Arguments : none
8937
8938 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8939 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8940 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8941 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8942 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8943 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8944 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8945 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8946 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008947 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8948 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008949 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8950
8951 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8952 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8953 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8954 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8955 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8956 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8957 are often the only way to detect them.
8958
8959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8961
8962 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8963
8964
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008965option http-keep-alive
8966no option http-keep-alive
8967 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8969 yes | yes | yes | yes
8970 Arguments : none
8971
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008972 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8973 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008974 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8975 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008976 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8977 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8978 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008979
8980 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8981 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008982 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8983 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8984 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8985 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8986 situations where this option may be useful :
8987
8988 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008989 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008990
8991 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8992 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8993
8994 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8995 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8996 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8997 request.
8998
8999 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
9000 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009001 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
9002 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
9003 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009004
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009005 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9006 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9007 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9008 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9009 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9010 not set.
9011
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009012 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9013 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
9014 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009015
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009016 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009017 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01009018 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009019
9020
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009021option http-no-delay
9022no option http-no-delay
9023 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9025 yes | yes | yes | yes
9026 Arguments : none
9027
9028 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9029 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9030 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9031 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9032 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9033 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9034 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009035 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009036 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9037 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9038 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9039 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9040 affected.
9041
9042 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9043 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9044 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9045 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9046 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9047 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9048 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9049 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9050 latency environments.
9051
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009052 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9053
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009054
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009055option http-pretend-keepalive
9056no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009057 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009059 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009060 Arguments : none
9061
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009062 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009063 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
9064 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
9065 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009066 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009067 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
9068 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
9069 consider the response complete.
9070
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009071 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009072 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009073 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009074 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009075 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009076 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9077
9078 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9079 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9080 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9081 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009082 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9083 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009084 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9085
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009086 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9087 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9088 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
9089 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
9090 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
9091 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009092
9093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9095
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009096 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009097 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009098
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009099option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9100 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9101 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9103 yes | yes | yes | yes
9104 Arguments :
9105 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9106 with no FastCGI application configured.
9107
9108 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9109 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9110 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9111
9112 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9113 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9114
9115 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9116 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9117 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9118 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9119 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9120 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9121 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9122 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9123
9124 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9125 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009126
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009127option http-server-close
9128no option http-server-close
9129 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
9130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9131 yes | yes | yes | yes
9132 Arguments : none
9133
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009134 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9135 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9136 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9137 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009138 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
9139 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
9140 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
9141 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
9142 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
9143 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
9144 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
9145 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
9146 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
9147 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
9148 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009149
9150 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9151 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9152 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9153 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009154 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9155 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009156
9157 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9158 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009159 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9160 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9161 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009162
9163 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9164 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9165
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009166 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
9167 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009168
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009169option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009170no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009171 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9173 yes | yes | yes | no
9174 Arguments : none
9175
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009176 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009177 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9178 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9179 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9180 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9181 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009182 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009183
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009184 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009185 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009186 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9187 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9188 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009189
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009190 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9191 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9192 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9193 front of an existing proxy.
9194
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009195 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009197 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009198
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009199option httpchk
9200option httpchk <uri>
9201option httpchk <method> <uri>
9202option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009203 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9205 yes | no | yes | yes
9206 Arguments :
9207 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9208 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9209 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9210 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9211 ones.
9212
9213 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9214 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9215 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9216
9217 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9218 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9219 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009220 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009221
9222 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9223 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9224 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9225 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9226 the lack of any response.
9227
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009228 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9229 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9230 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9231 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9232
9233 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9234 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9235 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009236
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009237 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9238 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009239 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009240 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009241 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009242
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009243 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
9244 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
9245 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
9246 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
9247
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009248 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009249 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9250 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9251 backend https_relay
9252 mode tcp
9253 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9254 http-check send hdr Host www
9255 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009256
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009257 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9258 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9259 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009260
9261
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009262option httpclose
9263no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009264 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9266 yes | yes | yes | yes
9267 Arguments : none
9268
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009269 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9270 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9271 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9272 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009273 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009274
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009275 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
9276 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009277 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009278 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
9279 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009280
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009281 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
9282 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
9283 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009284
9285 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9286 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009287 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
9288 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9289 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009290
9291 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9292 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9293
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009294 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009295
9296
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009297option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009298 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009300 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009301 Arguments :
9302 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9303 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9304 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009305 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009306 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009307
9308 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9309 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9310 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9311 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9312 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9313 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9314 ports.
9315
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009316 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9317 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009318
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009319 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009321 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009322
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009323option httpslog
9324 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9326 yes | yes | yes | no
9327
9328 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9329 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9330 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9331 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9332 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9333 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9334 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9335
9336 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9337
9338 See also : section 8 about logging.
9339
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009340
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009341option independent-streams
9342no option independent-streams
9343 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9345 yes | yes | yes | yes
9346 Arguments : none
9347
9348 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9349 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9350 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9351 receive data or not.
9352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009353 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009354 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9355 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9356 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9357 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9358 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9359 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9360 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9361 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9362 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9363 socket buffers.
9364
9365 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9366 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9367 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9368 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9369 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9370
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009371 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009372
9373
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009374option ldap-check
9375 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9377 yes | no | yes | yes
9378 Arguments : none
9379
9380 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9381 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9382 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9383 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9384
9385 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9386 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9387
9388 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9389 configure it.
9390
9391 Example :
9392 option ldap-check
9393
9394 See also : "option httpchk"
9395
9396
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009397option external-check
9398 Use external processes for server health checks
9399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9400 yes | no | yes | yes
9401
9402 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9403 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9404 command".
9405
9406 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9407
9408 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9409
9410
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009411option idle-close-on-response
9412no option idle-close-on-response
9413 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9415 yes | yes | yes | no
9416 Arguments : none
9417
9418 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9419 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9420 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9421 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9422 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9423 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9424 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9425 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9426 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9427
9428 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9429 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9430
9431 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9432 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9433 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9434 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9435
9436 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9437 "hard-stop-after"
9438
9439
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009440option log-health-checks
9441no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009442 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9444 yes | no | yes | yes
9445 Arguments : none
9446
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009447 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9448 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9449 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009450
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009451 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9452 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9453 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9454 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9455 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9456
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009457 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009458 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009459
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009460 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9461 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9462 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009463
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009464
9465option log-separate-errors
9466no option log-separate-errors
9467 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9469 yes | yes | yes | no
9470 Arguments : none
9471
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009472 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009473 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9474 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9475 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9476 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9477 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9478 provides very important information.
9479
9480 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9481 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9482 error logs.
9483
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009484 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009485 logging.
9486
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009487
9488option logasap
9489no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009490 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9492 yes | yes | yes | no
9493 Arguments : none
9494
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009495 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9496 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9497 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9498 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9499
9500 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9501 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9502 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9503 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9504 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009505 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009506 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9507 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9508 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9509 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009510 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009511
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009512 Examples :
9513 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9514 mode http
9515 option httplog
9516 option logasap
9517 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9518
9519 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9520 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9521 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9522 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009524 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009525 logging.
9526
9527
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009528option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009529 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9531 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009532 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009533 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9534 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009535 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9536 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009537
9538 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9539 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009540 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009541 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009542 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9543 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9544 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009545
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009546 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9547 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9548 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009549
9550 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009551 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009552 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9553 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9554 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9555 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9556 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9557 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9558 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9559
9560 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9561 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009562
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009563 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009564
9565 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9566 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9567 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9568 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009569 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009570 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009571
9572 See also: "option httpchk"
9573
9574
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009575option nolinger
9576no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009577 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9579 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009580 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009581
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009582 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009583 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9584 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9585 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9586 connections.
9587
9588 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9589 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009590 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9591 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9592 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9593 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9594 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9595 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9596 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9597 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9598 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9599 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9600 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9601 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9602 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009603
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009604 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9605 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9606 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9607 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9608 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009609
9610 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9611 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009612 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009613 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009614 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009615
9616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9618
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009619 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9620 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009621
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009622option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9623 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9625 yes | yes | yes | yes
9626 Arguments :
9627 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9628 matching <network>
9629 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9630 header name.
9631
9632 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9633 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9634 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9635 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9636 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9637 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9638 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9639 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9640 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9641 possible that the client has already brought one.
9642
9643 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9644 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9645 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9646 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9647 header and requires different one.
9648
9649 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9650 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9651 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009652 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9653 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9654 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9655 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9656 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009657
9658 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9659 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9660 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9661 both are defined.
9662
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009663 Examples :
9664 # Original Destination address
9665 frontend www
9666 mode http
9667 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9668
9669 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9670 backend www
9671 mode http
9672 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9673
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009674 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009675
9676
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009677option persist
9678no option persist
9679 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9681 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009682 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009683
9684 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9685 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9686 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9687 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9688 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9689 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9690 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9691 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9692 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9693 redirected to another valid server.
9694
9695 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9696 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9697
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009698 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009699
9700
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009701option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9702 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9704 yes | no | yes | yes
9705 Arguments :
9706 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9707 PostgreSQL server.
9708
9709 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9710 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9711 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9712 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9713
9714 See also: "option httpchk"
9715
9716
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009717option prefer-last-server
9718no option prefer-last-server
9719 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9721 yes | no | yes | yes
9722 Arguments : none
9723
9724 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009725 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009726 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9727 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009728 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009729 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009730 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009731 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9732 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009733 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009734 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009735 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9736 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9737 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009738 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9739 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9740 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009741
9742 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9743 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9744
9745 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9746
9747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009748option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009749option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009750no option redispatch
9751 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9752 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9753 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009754 Arguments :
9755 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9756 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9757 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009758 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009759 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009760 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009761 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9762 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9763 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009765
9766 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9767 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9768 be able to access the service anymore.
9769
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009770 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9771 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009772
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009773 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9774 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9775 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9776 following order:
9777
9778 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9779
9780 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9781 list, or
9782
9783 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9784
9785 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9786 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9787
9788 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9789 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9790 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9791 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9792
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009793 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009794 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9795 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009797 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9798 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9799
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009800 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009801
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009802
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009803option redis-check
9804 Use redis health checks for server testing
9805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9806 yes | no | yes | yes
9807 Arguments : none
9808
9809 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9810 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9811 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9812 find the "+PONG" response message.
9813
9814 Example :
9815 option redis-check
9816
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009817 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009818
9819
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009820option smtpchk
9821option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9822 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9824 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009825 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009826 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009827 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009828 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9829
9830 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9831 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9832 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9833
9834 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9835 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9836 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9837 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9838 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9839 dead server.
9840
9841 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9842 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009843 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009844 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9845
9846 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9847 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9848 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9849 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009850 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009851
9852 Example :
9853 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9854
9855 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009858option socket-stats
9859no option socket-stats
9860
9861 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9863 yes | yes | yes | no
9864
9865 Arguments : none
9866
9867
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009868option splice-auto
9869no option splice-auto
9870 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9872 yes | yes | yes | yes
9873 Arguments : none
9874
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009875 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009876 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009877 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009878 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009879 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009880 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9881 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9882 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9883 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9884
9885 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9886 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9887 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9888 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9889 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9890 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9891 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9892 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9893 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9894 keyword.
9895
9896 Example :
9897 option splice-auto
9898
9899 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9900 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9901
9902 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9903 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9904
9905
9906option splice-request
9907no option splice-request
9908 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9910 yes | yes | yes | yes
9911 Arguments : none
9912
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009913 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009914 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009915 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9916 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9917 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9918 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9919
9920 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9921
9922 Example :
9923 option splice-request
9924
9925 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9926 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9927
9928 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9929 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9930
9931
9932option splice-response
9933no option splice-response
9934 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9936 yes | yes | yes | yes
9937 Arguments : none
9938
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009939 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009940 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009941 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9942 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9943 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9944 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9945
9946 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9947
9948 Example :
9949 option splice-response
9950
9951 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9952 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9953
9954 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9955 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9956
9957
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009958option spop-check
9959 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9961 no | no | no | yes
9962 Arguments : none
9963
9964 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9965 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9966 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9967 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9968
9969 Example :
9970 option spop-check
9971
9972 See also : "option httpchk"
9973
9974
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009975option srvtcpka
9976no option srvtcpka
9977 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9979 yes | no | yes | yes
9980 Arguments : none
9981
9982 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9983 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009984 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009985 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9986
9987 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9988 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9989 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9990 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9991
9992 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9993 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9994 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9995 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9996 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9997
9998 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9999
10000 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10001 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10002 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10003
10004 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10005 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10006
10007 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10008
10009
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010010option ssl-hello-chk
10011 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10013 yes | no | yes | yes
10014 Arguments : none
10015
10016 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10017 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10018 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10019 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10020 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10021 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10022 hello message.
10023
10024 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10025 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10026 messages, which is appreciable.
10027
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010028 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010029 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10030 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010031
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010032 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10033
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010034
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010035option tcp-check
10036 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10038 yes | no | yes | yes
10039
10040 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10041 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10042
10043 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10044 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10045 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10046
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010047 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010048 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10049 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10050 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10051 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10052 only.
10053
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010054 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010055 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010056 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10057 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10058 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10059
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010060 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010061 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10062 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010063 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010064 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10065 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10066 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10067 the respective protocols.
10068 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010069 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010070
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010071 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010072
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010073 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10074 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10075 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10076 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010077
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010078 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10079 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10080 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010081
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010082
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010083 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010084 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010085 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010086 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010087
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010088 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010089 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010090 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010091
10092 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10093 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010094 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010095 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010096 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010097 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010098 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010099 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010100 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10101 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010102 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010103 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10104 tcp-check expect string +OK
10105
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010106 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010107 (send many headers before analyzing)
10108 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010109 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010110 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10111 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10112 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10113 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010114 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010115
10116
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010117 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010118
10119
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010120option tcp-smart-accept
10121no option tcp-smart-accept
10122 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10124 yes | yes | yes | no
10125 Arguments : none
10126
10127 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10128 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10129 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10130 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10131 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10132 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10133
10134 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10135 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10136 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10137 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10138
10139 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10140 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10141 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010142 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010143
10144 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10145 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10146 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10147
10148 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10149 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10150 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10151
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010152 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10153
10154
10155option tcp-smart-connect
10156no option tcp-smart-connect
10157 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10159 yes | no | yes | yes
10160 Arguments : none
10161
10162 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10163 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10164 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10165 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10166 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10167
10168 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10169 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10170 complex.
10171
10172 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10173 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10174 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10175
10176 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10177 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10178
10179 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10180
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010181
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010182option tcpka
10183 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10185 yes | yes | yes | yes
10186 Arguments : none
10187
10188 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10189 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010190 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010191 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10192
10193 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10194 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10195 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10196 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10197
10198 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10199 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10200 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10201 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10202 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10203
10204 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10205
10206 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10207 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10208 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10209 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10210 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10211 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10212 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10213 backends.
10214
10215 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10216
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010217
10218option tcplog
10219 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010221 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010222 Arguments : none
10223
10224 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10225 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10226 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10227 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10228 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10229 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10230 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10231 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10232
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010233 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010235 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010236
10237
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010238option transparent
10239no option transparent
10240 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010242 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010243 Arguments : none
10244
10245 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10246 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10247 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10248 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10249 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10250 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10251 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10252 appropriate server.
10253
10254 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10255 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10256
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010257 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010258 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010259
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010260
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010261external-check command <command>
10262 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10264 yes | no | yes | yes
10265
10266 Arguments :
10267 <command> is the external command to run
10268
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010269 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10270
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010271 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010272
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010273 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10274 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10275 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10276 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10277 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10278 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010279
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010280 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10281
10282 Environment variables :
10283 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10284 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10285
10286 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10287
10288 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10289
10290 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10291 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10292 for a UNIX socket).
10293
10294 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10295
10296 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10297
10298 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10299
10300 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10301
10302 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10303
10304 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10305 socket).
10306
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010307 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10308
10309 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10310 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10311 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10312 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10313 TCP server).
10314
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010315 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10316 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10317
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010318 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10319
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010320 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10321 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10322 failed.
10323
10324 Example :
10325 external-check command /bin/true
10326
10327 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10328
10329
10330external-check path <path>
10331 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10333 yes | no | yes | yes
10334
10335 Arguments :
10336 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10337
10338 The default path is "".
10339
10340 Example :
10341 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10342
10343 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10344 "external-check command"
10345
10346
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010347persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010348persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010349 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10351 yes | no | yes | yes
10352 Arguments :
10353 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010354 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10355 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010356
10357 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10358 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010359 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010360 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10361 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10362 forwarded to this server.
10363
10364 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10365 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10366 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010367 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010368 a single "listen" section.
10369
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010370 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10371 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10372 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10373
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010374 Example :
10375 listen tse-farm
10376 bind :3389
10377 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10378 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10379 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10380 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10381 persist rdp-cookie
10382 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010383 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010384 balance rdp-cookie
10385 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10386 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10387
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010388 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010389
10390
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010391rate-limit sessions <rate>
10392 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10394 yes | yes | yes | no
10395 Arguments :
10396 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10397 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10398
10399 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10400 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10401 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010402 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010403 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10404 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10405
10406 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10407 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10408 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10409 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10410
10411 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10412 listen smtp
10413 mode tcp
10414 bind :25
10415 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010416 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010417
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010418 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10419 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10420 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010421
10422 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10423
10424
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010425redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10426redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10427redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010428 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10430 no | yes | yes | yes
10431
10432 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010433 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010434
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010435 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010436 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010437 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10438 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10439 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010440
10441 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10442 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10443 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10444 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10445 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010446 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10447 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10448 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10449 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010450
10451 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10452 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10453 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10454 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10455 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10456 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010457 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010458 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010459 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10460 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10461 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010462
10463 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010464 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10465 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10466 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010467 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010468 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10469 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10470 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10471 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010472
10473 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010474 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010475
10476 - "drop-query"
10477 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10478 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10479 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10480 with a location-type redirect.
10481
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010482 - "append-slash"
10483 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10484 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10485 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10486 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10487
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010488 - "ignore-empty"
10489 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10490 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10491 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10492 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10493 of known paths using a simple map.
10494
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010495 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10496 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10497 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10498 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10499 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10500 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10501 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10502
10503 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10504 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10505 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10506 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10507 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10508 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10509 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010510
10511 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10512 acl clear dst_port 80
10513 acl secure dst_port 8080
10514 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010515 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010516 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010517 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10518
10519 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010520 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10521 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10522 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010523 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010524
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010525 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10526 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10527 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10528
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010529 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010530 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010531
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010532 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010533 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10534 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10535 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010536
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010537 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10538 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10539 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10540
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010541 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010542
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010543
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010544retries <value>
10545 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10546 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10547 yes | no | yes | yes
10548 Arguments :
10549 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10550 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10551 default value is 3.
10552
10553 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10554 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10555 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10556
10557 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010558 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10559 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010560
10561 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10562 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10563
10564 See also : "option redispatch"
10565
10566
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010567retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010568 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10569 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10570 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10572 yes | no | yes | yes
10573 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010574 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10575 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10576 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10577 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10578 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010579
10580 none never retry
10581
10582 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10583 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10584
10585 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10586 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10587 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10588 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10589 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10590 processing the request.
10591
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010592 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10593 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10594 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10595 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10596 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10597 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10598 overflow attack for example).
10599
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010600 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10601 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10602 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10603 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10604 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10605 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10606 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10607 amplify denial of service attacks.
10608
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010609 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10610 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10611 considered to be safe to retry.
10612
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010613 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10614 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10615 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10616 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10617 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010618
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010619 all-retryable-errors
10620 retry request for any error that are considered
10621 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10622 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10623 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10624
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010625 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10626 not cumulative.
10627
10628 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10629 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10630 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10631 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10632
10633 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10634 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10635 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10636 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10637 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10638 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10639 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10640 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10641 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10642 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10643 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10644 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10645
10646 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10647 should not use this directive.
10648
10649 The default is "conn-failure".
10650
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010651 Example:
10652 retry-on 503 504
10653
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010654 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10655
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010656server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010657 Declare a server in a backend
10658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10659 no | no | yes | yes
10660 Arguments :
10661 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010662 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010663 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010664
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010665 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10666 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10667 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10668 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010669 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10670 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010671 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010672 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10673 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010674 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10675 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10676 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10677 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10678 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10679 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10680 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010681 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010682 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10683 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10684 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10685 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10686 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10687 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010688 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10689 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010690 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10691 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010692
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010693 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010694 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10695 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10696 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10697 adding this value to the client's port.
10698
10699 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10700 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010701 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010702
10703 Examples :
10704 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10705 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010706 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010707 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10708 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10709 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010710
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010711 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10712 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10713 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10714 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10715 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10716
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010717 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10718 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010719
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010720server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010721 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010722 this backend.
10723 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10724 no | no | yes | yes
10725
10726 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10727 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10728 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10729 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10730 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010731
10732 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10733 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10734
10735 global
10736 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10737
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010738 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010739 load-server-state-from-file
10740
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010741 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010742 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010743
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010744server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10745 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10746 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10748 no | no | yes | yes
10749
10750 Arguments:
10751 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10752
10753 <num | range>
10754 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10755 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10756 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10757 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10758
10759 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10760
10761 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10762
10763 <params*>
10764 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10765 keyword.
10766
10767 Examples:
10768 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10769 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10770 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10771
10772 # or
10773 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10774
10775 # would be equivalent to:
10776 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10777 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10778 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10779
10780
10781
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010782source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010783source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010784source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010785 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10787 yes | no | yes | yes
10788 Arguments :
10789 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10790 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010791
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010792 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010793 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10794 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10795 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10796 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10797 supported prefixes are :
10798 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10799 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10800 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010801 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010802 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10803 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010804
10805 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10806 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010807 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10808 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10809 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010810
10811 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10812 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10813 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10814 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10815 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10816 <addr>.
10817
10818 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10819 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10820 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10821 port.
10822
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010823 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10824 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10825 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10826 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010827 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010828 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10829 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10830 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10831 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10832 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10833 HTTP header.
10834
10835 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10836 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010837 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010838 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10839 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10840 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10841 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10842 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10843 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10844 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10845
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010846 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10847 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10848 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10849 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10850 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10851 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10852
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010853 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10854 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10855 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10856 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10857
10858 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10859 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10860 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10861 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10862 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10863 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10864
10865 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10866 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10867 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10868 there are two methods :
10869
10870 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10871 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10872 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10873 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10874 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10875 of the client ranges may be used.
10876
10877 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10878 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10879 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10880 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10881 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10882 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10883 same session.
10884
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010885 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10886 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10887 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010888 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010889
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010890 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10891
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010892 Examples :
10893 backend private
10894 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10895 source 192.168.1.200
10896
10897 backend transparent_ssl1
10898 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10899 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10900
10901 backend transparent_ssl2
10902 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10903 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10904 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10905
10906 backend transparent_ssl3
10907 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10908 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10909 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10910
10911 backend transparent_smtp
10912 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10913 # with Tproxy version 4.
10914 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10915
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010916 backend transparent_http
10917 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10918 # proxy.
10919 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010921 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010922 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10923
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010924
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010925srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10926 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10927 the connection on the server side.
10928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10929 yes | no | yes | yes
10930 Arguments :
10931 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10932
10933 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10934 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010935 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10936 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010937
10938 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10939
10940
10941srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10942 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10943 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10944 server side.
10945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10946 yes | no | yes | yes
10947 Arguments :
10948 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10949 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10950 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10951 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10952
10953 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10954 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010955 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10956 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010957
10958 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10959
10960
10961srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10962 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10964 yes | no | yes | yes
10965 Arguments :
10966 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10967 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10968 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10969 document.
10970
10971 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10972 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010973 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10974 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010975
10976 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10977
10978
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010979stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10980 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010982 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010983
10984 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10985 matched.
10986
10987 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10988 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10989
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010990 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10991 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10992 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10993 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010994
10995 Example :
10996 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10997 backend stats_localhost
10998 stats enable
10999 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11000
11001 Example :
11002 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11003 backend stats_auth
11004 stats enable
11005 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11006 stats admin if TRUE
11007
11008 Example :
11009 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11010 userlist stats-auth
11011 group admin users admin
11012 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11013 group readonly users haproxy
11014 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11015
11016 backend stats_auth
11017 stats enable
11018 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11019 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11020 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11021 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11022
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011023 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11024 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011025
11026
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011027stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11028 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011030 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011031 Arguments :
11032 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11033
11034 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11035
11036 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11037 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11038 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11039 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11040 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11041 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11042
11043 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11044 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11045 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011046 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011047
11048 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11049 report using "stats scope".
11050
11051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11053 unobvious parameters.
11054
11055 Example :
11056 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11057 backend public_www
11058 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11059 stats enable
11060 stats hide-version
11061 stats scope .
11062 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011063 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011064 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11065 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11066
11067 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11068 backend private_monitoring
11069 stats enable
11070 stats uri /admin?stats
11071 stats refresh 5s
11072
11073 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11074
11075
11076stats enable
11077 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011079 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011080 Arguments : none
11081
11082 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11083 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11084 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11085 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11086 - stats auth : no authentication
11087 - stats scope : no restriction
11088
11089 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11090 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11091 unobvious parameters.
11092
11093 Example :
11094 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11095 backend public_www
11096 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11097 stats enable
11098 stats hide-version
11099 stats scope .
11100 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011101 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011102 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11103 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11104
11105 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11106 backend private_monitoring
11107 stats enable
11108 stats uri /admin?stats
11109 stats refresh 5s
11110
11111 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11112
11113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011114stats hide-version
11115 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011117 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011118 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011119
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011120 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11121 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11122 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11123 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11124 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11125 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011127 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11128 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11129 unobvious parameters.
11130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011131 Example :
11132 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11133 backend public_www
11134 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011135 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011136 stats hide-version
11137 stats scope .
11138 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011139 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011140 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11141 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011142
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011143 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11144 backend private_monitoring
11145 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011146 stats uri /admin?stats
11147 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011148
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011149 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011150
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011151
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011152stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11153 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11154 Access control for statistics
11155
11156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11157 no | no | yes | yes
11158
11159 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11160 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11161 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11162 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11163 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11164 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11165
11166 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11167 instance.
11168
11169 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11170 about ACL usage.
11171
11172
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011173stats realm <realm>
11174 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011176 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011177 Arguments :
11178 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11179 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11180 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11181
11182 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11183 using a backslash ('\').
11184
11185 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11186 only related to authentication.
11187
11188 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11189 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11190 unobvious parameters.
11191
11192 Example :
11193 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11194 backend public_www
11195 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11196 stats enable
11197 stats hide-version
11198 stats scope .
11199 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011200 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011201 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11202 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11203
11204 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11205 backend private_monitoring
11206 stats enable
11207 stats uri /admin?stats
11208 stats refresh 5s
11209
11210 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11211
11212
11213stats refresh <delay>
11214 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011216 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011217 Arguments :
11218 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11219 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11220 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11221 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11222 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11223 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11224
11225 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11226 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11227 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011228 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011229
11230 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11231 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11232 unobvious parameters.
11233
11234 Example :
11235 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11236 backend public_www
11237 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11238 stats enable
11239 stats hide-version
11240 stats scope .
11241 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011242 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011243 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11244 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11245
11246 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11247 backend private_monitoring
11248 stats enable
11249 stats uri /admin?stats
11250 stats refresh 5s
11251
11252 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11253
11254
11255stats scope { <name> | "." }
11256 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011258 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011259 Arguments :
11260 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11261 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11262 section in which the statement appears.
11263
11264 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11265 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11266 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11267 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11268 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11269 exists.
11270
11271 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11272 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11273 unobvious parameters.
11274
11275 Example :
11276 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11277 backend public_www
11278 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11279 stats enable
11280 stats hide-version
11281 stats scope .
11282 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011283 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011284 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11285 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11286
11287 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11288 backend private_monitoring
11289 stats enable
11290 stats uri /admin?stats
11291 stats refresh 5s
11292
11293 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11294
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011295
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011296stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011297 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011299 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011300
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011301 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011302 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11303
11304 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11305 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11306
11307 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11308 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011309 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011310
11311 Example :
11312 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11313 backend private_monitoring
11314 stats enable
11315 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11316 stats uri /admin?stats
11317 stats refresh 5s
11318
11319 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11320 global section.
11321
11322
11323stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011324 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11326 yes | yes | yes | yes
11327 Arguments : none
11328
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011329 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011330 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11331 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11332 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11333 - IP (socket, server)
11334 - cookie (backend, server)
11335
11336 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11337 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011338 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011339
11340 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11341
11342
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011343stats show-modules
11344 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11346 yes | yes | yes | yes
11347 Arguments : none
11348
11349 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11350 values as a tooltip.
11351
11352 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11353 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11354 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11355
11356 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11357
11358
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011359stats show-node [ <name> ]
11360 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011362 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011363 Arguments:
11364 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11365 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11366
11367 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11368 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011369 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011370
11371 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11372 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11373 unobvious parameters.
11374
11375 Example:
11376 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11377 backend private_monitoring
11378 stats enable
11379 stats show-node Europe-1
11380 stats uri /admin?stats
11381 stats refresh 5s
11382
11383 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11384 section.
11385
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011386
11387stats uri <prefix>
11388 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011390 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011391 Arguments :
11392 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11393 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11394 query string.
11395
11396 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11397 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11398 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11399 possible to reach it in the application.
11400
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011401 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011402 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011403 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11404 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11405 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11406 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11407
11408 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11409 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11410 an address or a port to statistics only.
11411
11412 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11413 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11414 unobvious parameters.
11415
11416 Example :
11417 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11418 backend public_www
11419 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11420 stats enable
11421 stats hide-version
11422 stats scope .
11423 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011424 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011425 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11426 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11427
11428 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11429 backend private_monitoring
11430 stats enable
11431 stats uri /admin?stats
11432 stats refresh 5s
11433
11434 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11435
11436
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011437stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11438 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011440 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011441
11442 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011443 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011444 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011445 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011446 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11447
11448 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11449 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11450 the "stick-table" statement.
11451
11452 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11453 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11454 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11455 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11456 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11457
11458 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11459 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11460 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11461 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11462 transformation rules.
11463
11464 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11465 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11466 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11467 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11468 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11469 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11470 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11471
11472 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11473 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11474 ACL based conditions.
11475
11476 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11477 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11478 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11479 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11480
11481 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11482 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11483 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11484 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11485
11486 Example :
11487 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11488 # last 30 minutes
11489 backend pop
11490 mode tcp
11491 balance roundrobin
11492 stick store-request src
11493 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11494 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11495 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11496
11497 backend smtp
11498 mode tcp
11499 balance roundrobin
11500 stick match src table pop
11501 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11502 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11503
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011504 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11505 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011506
11507
11508stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11509 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11511 no | no | yes | yes
11512
11513 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11514 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11515 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11516 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11517
11518 Examples :
11519 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011520 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011521
11522 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11523 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11524 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11525
11526
11527 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11528 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11529 backend http
11530 mode http
11531 balance roundrobin
11532 stick on src table https
11533 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11534 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11535 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11536
11537 backend https
11538 mode tcp
11539 balance roundrobin
11540 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11541 stick on src
11542 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11543 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11544
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011545 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011546
11547
11548stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11549 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11551 no | no | yes | yes
11552
11553 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011554 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011555 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011556 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011557 server is selected.
11558
11559 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11560 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11561 the "stick-table" statement.
11562
11563 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11564 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11565 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11566 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11567 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11568 address.
11569
11570 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11571 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11572 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11573 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11574 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11575 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11576 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11577 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11578 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11579 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11580
11581 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11582 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11583 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11584 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11585 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11586 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11587 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11588
11589 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11590 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11591 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11592 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11593
11594 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11595 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11596 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11597 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11598 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11599 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011600 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11601 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11602 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11603 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11604 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11605 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011606
11607 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11608 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11609 the request.
11610
11611 Example :
11612 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11613 # last 30 minutes
11614 backend pop
11615 mode tcp
11616 balance roundrobin
11617 stick store-request src
11618 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11619 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11620 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11621
11622 backend smtp
11623 mode tcp
11624 balance roundrobin
11625 stick match src table pop
11626 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11627 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11628
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011629 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011630
11631
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011632stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011633 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011634 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011635 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011637 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011638
11639 Arguments :
11640 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11641 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11642 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11643 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11644
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011645 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11646 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11647 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11648 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11649
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011650 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11651 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11652 instance.
11653
11654 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11655 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11656 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11657 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11658 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11659 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011660 to 32 characters.
11661
11662 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11663 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11664 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011665 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011666 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11667 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011668
11669 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011670 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11671 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011672 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11673 increase.
11674
11675 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011676 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11677 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11678 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011679
11680 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011681 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011682 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11683 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011684 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011685 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11686 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11687 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11688 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11689 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11690 parameter (see below).
11691
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011692 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11693 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11694 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11695 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11696 soft restart.
11697
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011698 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011699 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11700 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011701 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11702 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011703 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011704 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011705 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11706 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011707 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11708 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011709
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011710 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11711 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11712 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11713 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11714 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11715 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11716 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11717 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11718 token.
11719
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011720 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11721 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11722 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11723 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011724 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11725 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11726 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11727 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11728 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11729 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11730 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11731 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11732 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11733 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11734 types and their arguments.
11735
11736 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11737 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11738 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11739 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11740
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011741 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11742 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11743 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11744 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11745 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11746 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11747 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11748 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11749 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11750 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011751 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11752 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11753 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11754 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011755
11756 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11757 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11758 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11759 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11760 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11761 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010011762 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
11763 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
11764 update message can fit into the buffer.
11765 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
11766 store only the counter gpc0.
11767 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011768 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11769 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11770 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011771 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11772 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11773 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11774 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011775
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011776 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11777 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11778 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011779 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011780
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011781 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11782 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11783 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011784 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011785 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011786 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011787
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011788 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11789 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11790 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11791 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11792
11793 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11794 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11795 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11796 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11797 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11798 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11799
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011800 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11801 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11802 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11803 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11804 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010011805 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
11806 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
11807 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
11808 to store only the tag gpt0.
11809 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
11810 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
11811 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011812 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11813 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11814 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011815
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011816 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11817 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11818 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11819 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11820
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011821 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11822 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11823 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11824 they were received.
11825
11826 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11827 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11828 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11829 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11830 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11831
11832 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11833 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11834 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11835 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11836 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11837
11838 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11839 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11840 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11841
11842 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11843 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11844 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11845 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11846 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11847
11848 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11849 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11850 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11851 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11852 the client side.
11853
11854 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11855 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11856 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11857 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11858 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11859 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11860 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11861
11862 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11863 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11864 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11865 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11866 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11867 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011868 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011869
11870 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11871 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11872 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11873 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11874 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11875 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11876
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011877 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11878 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11879 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11880 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11881 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11882
11883 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11884 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11885 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11886 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11887 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11888 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11889
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011890 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011891 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011892 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11893 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11894
11895 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11896 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11897 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11898 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11899 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11900 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11901 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11902 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11903 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11904 recommended for better fairness.
11905
11906 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011907 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011908 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11909 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11910
11911 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11912 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11913 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11914 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11915 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11916 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11917 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11918 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11919 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11920 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011921
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011922 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11923 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011924 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11925 reference it.
11926
11927 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11928 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011929 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11930 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11931 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011932
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011933 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11934 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11935 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11936 something that can be ignored.
11937
11938 Example:
11939 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11940 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11941 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11942 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11943
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011944 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011945 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011946
11947
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011948stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011949 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11951 no | no | yes | yes
11952
11953 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011954 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011955 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011956 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011957 server is selected.
11958
11959 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11960 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11961 the "stick-table" statement.
11962
11963 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11964 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11965 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11966 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11967
11968 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11969 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11970 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11971 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11972 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11973 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011974 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011975 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11976 rules.
11977
11978 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11979 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11980 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11981 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11982 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11983 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11984 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11985
11986 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11987 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11988 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11989 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11990
11991 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11992 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11993 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11994 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11995 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11996 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011997 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11998 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11999 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12000 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12001 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12002 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12003 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12004 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12005 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012006
12007 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12008
12009 Example :
12010 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12011 backend https
12012 mode tcp
12013 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012014 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012015 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012016
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012017 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
12018 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012019
12020 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12021 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12022 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12023
12024 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12025 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012026
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012027 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12028 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12029 # at offset 44.
12030
12031 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012032 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012033
12034 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012035 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012036
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012037 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12038 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12039
12040 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12041 extraction.
12042
12043
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012044tcp-check comment <string>
12045 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12046 it fails.
12047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12048 yes | no | yes | yes
12049
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012050 Arguments :
12051 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12052 rule fails.
12053
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012054 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12055 user-friendly error reporting.
12056
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012057 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12058 "tcp-check expect".
12059
12060
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012061tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12062 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012063 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012064 Opens a new connection
12065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012066 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012067
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012068 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012069 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12070
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012071 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012072 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012073
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012074 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012075 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12076 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012077 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012078
12079 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012080
12081 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12082
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012083 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12084
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012085 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12086
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012087 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12088
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012089 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12090 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12091 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12092 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12093
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012094 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12095 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12096 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12097 haproxy -vv.
12098
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012099 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012100
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012101 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12102 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12103 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12104
12105 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12106 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12107 of the sequence.
12108
12109 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12110 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12111 do.
12112
12113 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12114 unset-var or comment rules.
12115
12116 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012117 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12118 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12119 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12120 option tcp-check
12121 tcp-check connect
12122 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12123 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12124 tcp-check send \r\n
12125 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12126 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12127 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12128 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12129 tcp-check send \r\n
12130 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12131 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12132
12133 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12134 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012135 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012136 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12137 tcp-check connect port 143
12138 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12139 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12140
12141 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12142
12143
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012144tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012145 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012146 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012147 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012148 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012149 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012150 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012151
12152 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012153 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12154
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012155 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12156 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12157 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12158 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12159 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12160 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12161 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12162 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12163 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12164 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12165
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012166 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012167 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12168 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012169 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12170 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12171 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12172
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012173 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12174 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12175 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012176 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12177 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012178 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12179 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012180 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12181 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012182 By default "L7OK" is used.
12183
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012184 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12185 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012186 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12187 supported :
12188 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12189 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012190 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12191 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12192 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12193 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12194 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012195
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012196 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012197 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012198 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12199 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12200 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12201 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012202 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12203
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012204 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12205 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12206 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12207 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12208
12209 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12210 informational message reported in logs if an error
12211 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12212 log-format string.
12213
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012214 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12215 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12216 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12217 followed by some converters.
12218
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012219 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12220 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12221 with the usual backslash ('\').
12222 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012223 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012224 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12225 used upper or lower case.
12226
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012227 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12228
12229 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12230 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12231 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12232 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12233 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12234 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12235 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12236 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12237
12238 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12239 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12240 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12241 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12242 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12243 expression.
12244
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012245 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12246 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12247 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12248 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12249 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12250 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12251
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012252 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12253 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12254 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12255 this exact hexadecimal string.
12256 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12257
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012258 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12259 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12260 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12261 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12262 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12263 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12264 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12265 size.
12266
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012267 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12268 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12269 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12270 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12271 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12272 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12273 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12274 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12275 in a binary string before matching the response's
12276 buffer.
12277
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012278 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012279 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012280 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12281 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12282 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12283 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12284 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12285 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12286 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12287 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12288 the null character.
12289
12290 Examples :
12291 # perform a POP check
12292 option tcp-check
12293 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12294
12295 # perform an IMAP check
12296 option tcp-check
12297 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12298
12299 # look for the redis master server
12300 option tcp-check
12301 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012302 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012303 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12304 tcp-check expect string role:master
12305 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12306 tcp-check expect string +OK
12307
12308
12309 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012310 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012311
12312
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012313tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12314tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12315 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12316 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012317 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012318 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012319
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012320 Arguments :
12321 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12322
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012323 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12324 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012325
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012326 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12327 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012328
12329 Examples :
12330 # look for the redis master server
12331 option tcp-check
12332 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12333 tcp-check expect string role:master
12334
12335 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012336 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012337
12338
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012339tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12340tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12341 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12342 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012343 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012344 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012345
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012346 Arguments :
12347 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012348
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012349 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12350 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012351
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012352 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12353 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12354 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012355
12356 Examples :
12357 # redis check in binary
12358 option tcp-check
12359 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12360 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12361
12362
12363 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012364 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012365
12366
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012367tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12368tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012369 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012370 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012371 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012372
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012373 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012374 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12375 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12376 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12377 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12378 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12379 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12380 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12381 and '-'.
12382
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012383 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12384 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012385 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012386 conditions.
12387
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012388 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12389
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012390 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12391 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12392
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012393 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012394 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012395 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012396
12397
12398tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012399 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012400 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012401 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012402
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012403 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012404 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12405 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12406 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12407 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12408 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12409 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12410 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12411 and '-'.
12412
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012413 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012414 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12415
12416
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012417tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012418 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012420 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012421 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012422 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12423 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012424
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012425 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012426
12427 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12428 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012429 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12430 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12431 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12432 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12433 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12434 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012435
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012436 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12437 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12438 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012439 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12440 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12441 is true.
12442
12443 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12444 supported:
12445 - accept
12446 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12447 - expect-proxy layer4
12448 - reject
12449 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12450 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12451 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12452 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12453 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12454 - set-dst <expr>
12455 - set-dst-port <expr>
12456 - set-mark <mark>
12457 - set-src <expr>
12458 - set-src-port <expr>
12459 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012460 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12461 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012462 - silent-drop
12463 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12464 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12465 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012466 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012467
12468 The supported actions are described below.
12469
12470 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12471 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012472
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012473 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12474 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12475 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12476 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12477 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12478 a defaults section defining such rules.
12479
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012480 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12481 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12482 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012483
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012484 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12485 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12486 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012487
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012488 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12489 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12490 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012491
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012492 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12493 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12494 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012495
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012496 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12497 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12498 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012499
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012500 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012501
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012502 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012503
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012504 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012505
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012506 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012507
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012508tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012509
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012510 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12511 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012512
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012513tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12514 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012515
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012516 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12517 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12518 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12519 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12520 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12521 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12522 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012523
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012524tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012525
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012526 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12527 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12528 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12529 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12530 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12531 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012532
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012533tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012534
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012535 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12536 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12537 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12538 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12539 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12540 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12541 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12542 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12543 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12544 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12545 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012546
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012547tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12548tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12549tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012550
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012551 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12552 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12553 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12554 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012555
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012556tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12557 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12558tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12559 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012560
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012561 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12562 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12563 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012564
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012565tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12566tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012567
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012568 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12569 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12570 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012571
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012572tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012573
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012574 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12575 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12576 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012577
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012578tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12579tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012580
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012581 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12582 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12583 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012584
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012585tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012586
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012587 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12588 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12589 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012590
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012591tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12592tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012593
12594 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12595 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12596 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12597 for a complete description.
12598
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012599tcp-request connection silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012600
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012601 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12602 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12603 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12604 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012605
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012606tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12607tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12608tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012609
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012610 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12611 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12612 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012613
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012614tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12615
12616 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12617 details about variables.
12618
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012619
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012620tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12621 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012623 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012624 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012625 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12626 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012627
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012628 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012629
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012630 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012631 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12632 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012633 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12634 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012636 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12637 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12638 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12639 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012640 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012641 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012642 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12643 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12644 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12645 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012646 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012647 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012648
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012649 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12650 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12651 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12652 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012653
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012654 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12655 supported:
12656 - accept
12657 - capture <sample> len <length>
12658 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12659 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012660 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012661 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012662 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012663 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012664 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012665 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020012666 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012667 - set-dst <expr>
12668 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012669 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012670 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012671 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012672 - set-priority-class <expr>
12673 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012674 - set-src <expr>
12675 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012676 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012677 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12678 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012679 - silent-drop
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012680 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012681 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12682 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12683 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012684 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012685 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012686
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012687 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012688
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012689 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12690 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12691 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12692 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12693 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12694 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012695
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012696 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12697 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12698 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12699 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12700 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12701 a defaults section defining such rules.
12702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012703 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012704 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12705 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012706
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012707 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12708 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12709 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12710 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12711 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12712 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12713
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012714 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012715 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12716 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12717 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12718 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12719 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12720 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12721 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12722 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12723 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12724 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012725
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012726 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012727 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12728 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12729 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012730
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012731 Example:
12732 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12733
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012734 Example:
12735
12736 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012737 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012738 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012739
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012740 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012741 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012742 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012743 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12744 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012745 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012746 tcp-request content reject
12747
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012748 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12749 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12750 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12751 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12752 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12753 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12754 ...
12755 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12756
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012757 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012758 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12759 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012760 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012761 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012762
12763 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12764 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012765 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012766 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012767 tcp-request content reject
12768
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012769 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012770 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012771 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012772 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012773 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12774 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012775
12776 Example:
12777 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12778 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012779 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012780
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012781 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012782 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012783
12784 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012785 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012786 # protecting all our sites
12787 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012788 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12789 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012790 ...
12791 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12792
12793 backend http_dynamic
12794 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012795 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012796 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012797 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012798 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012799 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012800 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012802 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012803
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012804 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12805 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012806
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012807tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12808
12809 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010012810 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012811
12812tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
12813 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12814
12815 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
12816 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
12817 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
12818 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
12819 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
12820 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
12821 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
12822 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
12823 information.
12824
12825tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12826
12827 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
12828 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
12829 complete description.
12830
12831tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12832
12833 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
12834 are evaluated.
12835
12836tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12837tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12838tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12839
12840 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12841 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12842 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12843 description.
12844
12845tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12846 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12847tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12848 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12849
12850 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12851 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12852 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
12853
12854tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12855 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12856
12857 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12858 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
12859
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020012860tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
12861 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12862
12863 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
12864 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
12865 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
12866
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012867tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12868tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12869
12870 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12871 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12872 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12873
12874tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12875
12876 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12877 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
12878
12879tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12880
12881 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12882 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12883 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12884
12885tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12886
12887 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12888 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
12889
12890tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12891
12892 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
12893 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
12894
12895tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12896
12897 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
12898 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
12899 description.
12900
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012901tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12902tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12903
12904 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12905 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12906 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12907
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012908tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12909
12910 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12911 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12912 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12913
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012914tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12915tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012916
12917 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12918 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12919 for a complete description.
12920
12921tcp-request content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12922
12923 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12924 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12925 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12926 complete description.
12927
12928tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
12929 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12930
12931 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
12932 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
12933 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
12934 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
12935 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
12936 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
12937 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
12938 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
12939 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
12940 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12941
12942 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12943
12944tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12945tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12946tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12947
12948 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12949 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12950 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12951
12952tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12953
12954 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12955 details about variables.
12956
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020012957tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012958
12959 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
12960 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
12961 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
12962 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
12963 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
12964
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012965
12966tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12967 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012969 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012970 Arguments :
12971 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12972 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12973 as explained at the top of this document.
12974
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012975 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012976 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12977 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12978 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12979 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12980
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012981 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12982 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12983 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12984 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12985
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012986 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012987 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012988 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012989 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012990 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012991 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12992 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12993 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012994
12995 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12996 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12997 it pass through unaffected.
12998
12999 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13000 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13001 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013002 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013003 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13004 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013005 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13006 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13007 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013008
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013009 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13010 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13011
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013012 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013013 "timeout client".
13014
13015
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013016tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13017 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013019 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013020 Arguments :
13021 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13022 below.
13023
13024 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13025
13026 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13027 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13028 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13029 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013030 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013031 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13032 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13033 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13034 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13035 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13036 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13037 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13038 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13039 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13040 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13041 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13042 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13043 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13044 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13045 instead.
13046
13047 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13048 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13049 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13050 rules which may be inserted.
13051
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013052 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13053 supported:
13054 - accept
13055 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013056 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13057 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13058 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13059 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13060 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013061 - set-dst <expr>
13062 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013063 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013064 - set-src <expr>
13065 - set-src-port <expr>
13066 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013067 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13068 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013069 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013070 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13071 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13072 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13073 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013074
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013075 The supported actions are described below.
13076
13077 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13078 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13079 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13080 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13081 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13082 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013083
13084 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13085 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13086 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13087
13088 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13089 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13090 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13091 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13092 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13093
13094 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13095 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13096
13097 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13098 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13099 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13100
13101 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13102 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13103 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13104
13105 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13106 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13107 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13108
13109 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13110 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13111 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13112
13113 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13114
13115 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13116
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013117tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13118
13119 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13120 rules are evaluated.
13121
13122tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13123
13124 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13125 are evaluated.
13126
13127tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13128tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13129tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13130
13131 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13132 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13133 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13134 description.
13135
13136tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13137 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13138tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13139 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13140
13141 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13142 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
13143 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
13144 description.
13145
13146tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13147tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13148
13149 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13150 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13151 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13152
13153tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13154
13155 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13156 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13157 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13158
13159tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13160tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13161
13162 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13163 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13164 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13165
13166tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13167
13168 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13169 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13170 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13171
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013172tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13173tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013174
13175 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13176 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13177 for a complete description.
13178
13179tcp-request session silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13180
13181 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13182 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13183 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13184 complete description.
13185
13186tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13187tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13188tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13189
13190 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13191 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13192 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13193
13194tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13195
13196 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13197 details about variables.
13198
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013199
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013200tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13201 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
13202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013203 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013204 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013205 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13206 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013207
13208 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13209
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013210 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013211 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13212 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013213 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13214 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013215
13216 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13217
13218 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13219 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13220 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13221 inserted.
13222
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013223 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13224 supported:
13225 - accept
13226 - close
13227 - reject
13228 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13229 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13230 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13231 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13232 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13233 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013234 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013235 - set-log-level <level>
13236 - set-mark <mark>
13237 - set-nice <nice>
13238 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013239 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13240 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013241 - silent-drop
13242 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13243
13244 The supported actions are described below.
13245
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013246 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13247 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13248 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13249 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13250 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13251 a defaults section defining such rules.
13252
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013253 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13254 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13255 for changing the default action to a reject.
13256
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013257 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013258
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013259 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13260 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13261 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13262 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13263 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013264
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013265 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013266
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013267 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013268
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013269tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013270
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013271 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13272 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013273
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013274tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013275
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013276 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13277 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13278 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13279 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13280 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13281 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013282
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013283tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013284
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013285 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13286 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013287
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013288tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13289tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13290tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013291
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013292 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13293 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13294 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13295 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013296
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013297tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13298 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13299tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13300 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013301
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013302 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13303 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13304 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013305
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013306tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13307 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013308
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013309 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13310 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013311
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013312
13313tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
13314 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13315
13316 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13317 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13318 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13319
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013320tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013321
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013322 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13323 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013324
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013325tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013326
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013327 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13328 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13329 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013330
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013331tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013332
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013333 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13334 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013335
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013336tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013337
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013338 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13339 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13340 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013341
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013342tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13343tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013344
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013345 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13346 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13347 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013348
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013349tcp-response content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013350
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013351 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13352 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13353 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13354 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013355
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013356tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013357
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013358 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13359 details about variables.
13360
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013361
13362tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13363 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013365 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013366 Arguments :
13367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13369 as explained at the top of this document.
13370
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013371 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13372 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013373
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013374 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13375
13376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013377timeout check <timeout>
13378 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13379 established.
13380
13381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13382 yes | no | yes | yes
13383 Arguments:
13384 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13385 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13386 as explained at the top of this document.
13387
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013388 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013389 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013390 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013391 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013392 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13393 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13394 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013395
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013396 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013397 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13398
13399 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13400 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013401 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013402
13403 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13404 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13405 forget about it.
13406
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013407 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13408 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13409
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013410 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13411 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013412
13413
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013414timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013415 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13417 yes | yes | yes | no
13418 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013419 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013420 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13421 as explained at the top of this document.
13422
13423 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13424 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13425 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013426 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13427 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13428 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13429 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013430 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13431 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13432 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013433 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013434 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013435 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13436 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013437 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13438 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013439
13440 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13441 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13442 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13443 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013444 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013445 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13446
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013447 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013448
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013449
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013450timeout client-fin <timeout>
13451 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13453 yes | yes | yes | no
13454 Arguments :
13455 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13456 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13457 as explained at the top of this document.
13458
13459 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13460 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13461 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13462 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13463 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13464 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13465 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013466 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13467 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13468 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013469
13470 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13471 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13472 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13473
13474 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13475
13476
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013477timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013478 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13480 yes | no | yes | yes
13481 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013482 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013483 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13484 as explained at the top of this document.
13485
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013486 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013487 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013488 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013489 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013490 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13491 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013492
13493 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13494 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13495 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13496 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013497 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013498 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13499
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013500 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013502
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013503timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13504 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13506 yes | yes | yes | yes
13507 Arguments :
13508 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13509 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13510 as explained at the top of this document.
13511
13512 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13513 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13514 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13515 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13516 once the request has started to present itself.
13517
13518 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13519 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13520 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13521 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13522 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13523
13524 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13525 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13526 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13527 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13528
13529 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13530 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013531 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013532 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13533 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013534 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013535
13536 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13537 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13538 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13539 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13540
13541 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13542
13543
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013544timeout http-request <timeout>
13545 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013547 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013548 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013549 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013550 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13551 as explained at the top of this document.
13552
13553 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13554 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13555 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13556 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13557 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13558 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13559 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013560 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13561 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13562 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13563 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013564 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013565 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13566 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013567
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013568 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13569 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13570 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13571 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13572 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013573 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013574
13575 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13576 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013577 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013578 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13579 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13580
13581 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013582 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13583 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13584 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013585
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013586 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013587 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013588
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013589
13590timeout queue <timeout>
13591 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13593 yes | no | yes | yes
13594 Arguments :
13595 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13596 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13597 as explained at the top of this document.
13598
13599 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13600 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13601 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13602 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13603 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13604
13605 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13606 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13607 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13608 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13609
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013610 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013611
13612
13613timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013614 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13616 yes | no | yes | yes
13617 Arguments :
13618 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13619 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13620 as explained at the top of this document.
13621
13622 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13623 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13624 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13625 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13626 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13627 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13628 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13629
13630 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13631 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13632 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13633 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13634 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013635 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013636 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013637 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13638 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013639 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13640 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013641
13642 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13643 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13644 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13645 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013646 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013647 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13648
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013649 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013650
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013651
13652timeout server-fin <timeout>
13653 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13655 yes | no | yes | yes
13656 Arguments :
13657 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13658 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13659 as explained at the top of this document.
13660
13661 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13662 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13663 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13664 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13665 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13666 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13667 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13668 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13669 situations, it should not be needed.
13670
13671 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13672 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13673 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13674
13675 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13676
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013677
13678timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013679 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13681 yes | yes | yes | yes
13682 Arguments :
13683 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13684 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13685 as explained at the top of this document.
13686
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013687 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13688 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13689 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013690
13691 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13692 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13693 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13694 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013695 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013696
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013697 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013698
13699
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013700timeout tunnel <timeout>
13701 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13703 yes | no | yes | yes
13704 Arguments :
13705 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13706 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13707 as explained at the top of this document.
13708
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013709 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013710 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13711 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13712 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013713 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13714 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013715 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13716 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13717 specified.
13718
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013719 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13720 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13721 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13722 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13723 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13724 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13725 state.
13726
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013727 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13728 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13729 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13730 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013731 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013732
13733 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13734 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13735 forget about it.
13736
13737 Example :
13738 defaults http
13739 option http-server-close
13740 timeout connect 5s
13741 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013742 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013743 timeout server 30s
13744 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13745
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013746 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013747
13748
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013749transparent (deprecated)
13750 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013753 Arguments : none
13754
13755 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13756 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13757 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13758 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13759 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13760 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13761 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13762 appropriate server.
13763
13764 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13765
13766 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13767 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13768
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013769 See also: "option transparent"
13770
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013771unique-id-format <string>
13772 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13774 yes | yes | yes | no
13775 Arguments :
13776 <string> is a log-format string.
13777
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013778 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13779 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13780 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13781 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013782
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013783 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013784 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013785 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13786 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13787 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13788 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13789 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13790 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013791
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013792 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13793 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013794
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013795 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013796
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013797 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013798
13799 will generate:
13800
13801 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13802
13803 See also: "unique-id-header"
13804
13805unique-id-header <name>
13806 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13808 yes | yes | yes | no
13809 Arguments :
13810 <name> is the name of the header.
13811
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013812 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13813 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013814
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013815 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013816
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013817 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013818 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13819
13820 will generate:
13821
13822 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13823
13824 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013825
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013826use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013827 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13829 no | yes | yes | no
13830 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013831 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13832 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013833
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013834 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13835 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013836
13837 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13838 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13839 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013840 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013841 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013842 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13843 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013844
13845 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13846 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13847 assign the backend.
13848
13849 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13850 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13851 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13852 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13853 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13854 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13855
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013856 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013857 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013858 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13859 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13860 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13861
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013862 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13863 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13864 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13865 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13866 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13867 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13868 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13869 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13870 cannot be forced from the request.
13871
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013872 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013873 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13874 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13875
13876 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13877 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013878
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013879use-fcgi-app <name>
13880 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13882 no | no | yes | yes
13883 Arguments :
13884 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13885
13886 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013887
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013888use-server <server> if <condition>
13889use-server <server> unless <condition>
13890 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13892 no | no | yes | yes
13893 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013894 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13895 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013896
13897 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13898
13899 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13900 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13901 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13902
13903 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13904 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13905 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13906 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13907 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13908 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13909 matches will assign the server.
13910
13911 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13912 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13913 with the next rules until one matches.
13914
13915 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13916 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13917 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13918 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13919
13920 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13921 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13922 stripped.
13923
13924 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13925 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013926 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013927 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013928 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013929
13930 Example :
13931 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013932 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013933 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013934 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013935 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013936 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013937 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013938 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13939 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13940
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013941 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13942 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13943 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13944 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013945 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013946 and we fall back to load balancing.
13947
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013948 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013949
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013950
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139515. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013952--------------------------
13953
13954The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13955depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13956settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13957written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13958described in this section.
13959
13960
139615.1. Bind options
13962-----------------
13963
13964The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13965as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13966no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13967parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13968while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13969provided immediately after the setting name.
13970
13971The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13972
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013973accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13974 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13975 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13976 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13977 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13978 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13979 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13980 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13981 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13982 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013983 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13984 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13985 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013986
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013987accept-proxy
13988 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013989 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13990 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013991 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13992 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13993 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13994 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013995 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013996 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13997 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013998 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13999 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014000
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014001allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014002 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014003 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014004 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014005 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14006 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014007
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014008alpn <protocols>
14009 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14010 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14011 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014012 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014013 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014014 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
14015 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14016 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
14017 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
14018 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
14019 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
14020 preference, like below :
14021
14022 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014023
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014024 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14025 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
14026
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014027backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014028 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014029 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14030
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014031curves <curves>
14032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14033 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14034 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14035 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14036 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14037 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14038
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014039ecdhe <named curve>
14040 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014041 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14042 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014043
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014044ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14046 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014047 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14048 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014049 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014050
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014051 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14052 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14053 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14054 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14055 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
14056 extremely unsecure.
14057
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014058ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14059 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14060 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
14061 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14062 error is ignored.
14063
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014064ca-sign-file <cafile>
14065 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14066 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14067 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14068 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14069 'generate-certificates' for details.
14070
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014071ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014072 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14073 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14074 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14075 'generate-certificates' for details.
14076
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014077ca-verify-file <cafile>
14078 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14079 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14080 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14081 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14082 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14083
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014084ciphers <ciphers>
14085 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14086 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014087 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014088 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014089 information and recommendations see e.g.
14090 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14091 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14092 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14093
14094ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14095 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14096 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14097 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14098 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014099 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14100 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014101
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014102crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14104 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014105 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14106 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014107
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014108crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014109 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14110 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14111 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14112 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14113 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014114 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14115 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014116
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014117 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14118 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14119
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014120 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14121 are loaded.
14122
14123 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010014124 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020014125 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
14126 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
14127 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
14128 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
14129 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
14130 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
14131 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
14132 www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014133
14134 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
14135 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
14136 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
14137 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010014138 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
14139 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014140
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020014141 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014142
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014143 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014144 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014145 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
14146 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014147 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
14148 clients).
14149
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014150 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014151 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
14152 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
14153 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
14154 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
14155 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
14156 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
14157 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
14158 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
14159 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
14160 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
14161 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
14162 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
14163
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014164 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010014165 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
14166 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
14167 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
14168 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
14169
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050014170 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
14171 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
14172 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
14173 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014174
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014175 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
14176 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
14177 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014178
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014179crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014180 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014181 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014182 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014183 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014184
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014185crt-list <file>
14186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014187 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
14188 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014189
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014190 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
14191
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020014192 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
14193 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
14194 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
14195 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
14196 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014197
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014198 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014199 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
14200 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
14201 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
14202 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
14203 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014204 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
14205 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
14206 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014207
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014208 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
14209 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
14210 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014211
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014212 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
14213
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014214 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014215 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014216 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
14217 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
14218 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
14219 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
14220 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
14221 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014222
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014223 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014224 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014225 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014226 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014227 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014228 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014229
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014230defer-accept
14231 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14232 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14233 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014234 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014235 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14236 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14237 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14238 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14239 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14240 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14241 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14242
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014243expose-fd listeners
14244 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14245 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014246 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14247 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014248 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014249
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014250force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014251 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014252 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014253 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014254 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014255
14256force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014257 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014258 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014259 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014260
14261force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014262 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014263 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014264 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014265
14266force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014267 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014268 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014269 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014270
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014271force-tlsv13
14272 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14273 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014274 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014275
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014276generate-certificates
14277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14278 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14279 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14280 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14281 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14282 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14283 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14284 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14285 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14286 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14287 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14288
14289 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14290 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014291 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014292 certificate is used many times.
14293
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014294gid <gid>
14295 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14296 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14297 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14298 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14299 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14300
14301group <group>
14302 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14303 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14304 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14305 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14306 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14307
14308id <id>
14309 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14310 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14311 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14312 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14313
14314interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014315 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14316 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14317 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14318 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14319 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14320 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014321 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14322 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14323 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14324 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14325 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14326 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014327
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014328level <level>
14329 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14330 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14331 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014332 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014333 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14334 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14335 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014336 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014337 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014338 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014339 all counters).
14340
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014341severity-output <format>
14342 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14343 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14344 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14345 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14346 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14347 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14348 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14349 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14350 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14351 rfc5424 convention.
14352
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014353maxconn <maxconn>
14354 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14355 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14356 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14357 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14358 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14359 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14360 eat all memory.
14361
14362mode <mode>
14363 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14364 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14365 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14366 UNIX sockets.
14367
14368mss <maxseg>
14369 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14370 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14371 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14372 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14373 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14374 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14375 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14376 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14377 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14378 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14379 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14380
14381name <name>
14382 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14383 page.
14384
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014385namespace <name>
14386 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14387 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14388 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14389 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014391nice <nice>
14392 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14393 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14394 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14395 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14396 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14397 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14398 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14399 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14400 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14401 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14402 one for an RDP socket.
14403
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014404no-ca-names
14405 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14406 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014407 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014408
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014409no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014410 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014411 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014412 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014413 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014414 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14415 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014416
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014417no-tls-tickets
14418 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14419 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14420 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014421 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14422 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014423 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14424 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14425 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014426
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014427no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014429 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014430 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014431 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014432 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14433 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014434
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014435no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014436 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014437 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014438 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014439 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014440 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14441 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014442
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014443no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014444 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014445 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014446 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014447 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014448 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14449 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014450
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014451no-tlsv13
14452 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14453 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14454 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14455 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014456 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14457 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014458
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014459npn <protocols>
14460 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14461 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14462 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014463 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014464 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014465 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14466 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14467 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14468 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14469 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014470
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014471prefer-client-ciphers
14472 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14473 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14474 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014475 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14476 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14477 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014478
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014479proto <name>
14480 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14481 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14482 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014483 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14484 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14485
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014486 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14487 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14488 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014489
14490 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14491 a bind line :
14492
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014493 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014494 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14495 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14496
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014497 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014498 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014499 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014500 h2" on the bind line.
14501
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020014502quic-cc-algo [ cubic | newreno ]
14503 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14504
14505 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
14506 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
14507 to those used by TCP.
14508
14509 Default value: cubic
14510
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014511quic-force-retry
14512 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14513 change without deprecation in the future.
14514
14515 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
14516 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
14517 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
14518 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
14519 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
14520 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
14521 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
14522 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting). To be functional this setting needs a
14523 cluster secret to be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret"
14524 setting).
14525
14526 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
14527 information about QUIC retry.
14528
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014529shards <number> | by-thread
14530 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14531 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14532 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14533 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14534 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14535 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14536 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14537 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14538 little bit.
14539
14540 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14541 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14542 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14543 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14544 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14545 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14546
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014547ssl
14548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014549 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014550 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14551 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014552 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14553 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014554
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014555ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14556 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014557 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14558 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14559 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014560 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14561
14562ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014563 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14564 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14565 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14566 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014567
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014568strict-sni
14569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14570 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14571 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14572 See the "crt" option for more information.
14573
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014574tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014575 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014576 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014577 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014578 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014579 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14580 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14581 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14582 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14583 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14584 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14585 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14586
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014587tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014588 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014589 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14590 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14591 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14592 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14593 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14594 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14595 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014596 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14597 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14598 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014599
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014600thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014601 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14602 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14603 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014604
14605 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14606 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14607 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14608 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14609 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14610 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14611 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14612 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14613 of the parsing.
14614
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014615 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014616 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14617 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014618
14619 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14620
14621 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14622 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14623 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14624 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14625 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14626 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14627
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014628tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14629 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014630 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14631 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14632 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14633 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14634 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14635 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14636 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14637 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14638 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14639 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014640 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14641 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14642
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014643transparent
14644 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14645 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14646 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14647 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14648 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14649 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14650 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14651 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14652 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14653 so check for support with your vendor.
14654
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014655v4v6
14656 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14657 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14658 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14659 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014660 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014661
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014662v6only
14663 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14664 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14665 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014666 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14667 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014668
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014669uid <uid>
14670 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14671 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14672 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14673 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14674 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14675
14676user <user>
14677 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14678 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14679 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14680 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14681 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14682
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014683verify [none|optional|required]
14684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14685 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14686 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14687 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14688 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014689 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14690 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14691 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14692 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014693
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200146945.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014695------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014697The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14698which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14699arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14700settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14701after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14702Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14703address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014705 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014706 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014707
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014708Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14709keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014711The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014712
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014713addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014714 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014715 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14716 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14717 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14718 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14719 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014720
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014721agent-check
14722 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014723 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014724 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14725 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14726 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014727
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014728 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014729 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014730 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014731 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14732 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014733
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014734 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14735 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14736 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14737 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14738 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014739
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014740 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014741 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014742
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014743 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14744 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14745 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014746
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014747 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14748 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14749 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014750
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014751 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014752 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14753 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14754 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14755 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014756 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014757 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014758
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014759 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14760 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014761
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014762 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14763 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14764 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14765 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14766 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14767 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14768 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14769 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14770 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014771
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014772 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14773 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014774 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14775 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14776 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014777 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014778
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014779 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014780 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014781
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014782agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014783 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014784 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14785 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14786 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14787 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14788
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014789agent-inter <delay>
14790 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14791 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14792
14793 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14794 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14795 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14796 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14797 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14798 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14799 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14800 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14801 of backends use the same servers.
14802
14803 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14804
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014805agent-addr <addr>
14806 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14807
14808 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014809 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014810 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14811 hostname, it will be resolved.
14812
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014813agent-port <port>
14814 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14815
14816 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14817
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014818allow-0rtt
14819 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014820 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14821 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014822
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014823alpn <protocols>
14824 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14825 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14826 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014827 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014828 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14829 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14830 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14831 now obsolete NPN extension.
14832 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14833 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14834
14835 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14836
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014837 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014839backup
14840 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14841 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14842 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14843 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014844 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14845 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014846
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014847ca-file <cafile>
14848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14849 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014850 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14851 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014852 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014853
14854 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
14855 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
14856 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014858check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014859 This option enables health checks on a server:
14860 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14861 considered available.
14862 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14863 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14864 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14865 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14866 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014867 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
14868 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014869 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14870 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14871 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14872 exchanges succeed.
14873
14874 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14875 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14876 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14877 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14878 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014879 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014880 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14881
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014882 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020014883 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014884 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
14885 not overridden.
14886
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014887 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14888 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14889
14890 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14891 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14892
14893 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14894 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14895 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14896 available.
14897
14898 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14899 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14900 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14901
14902 Example:
14903 # simple tcp check
14904 backend foo
14905 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14906 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14907 backend foo
14908 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14909 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14910 backend foo
14911 option tcp-check
14912 tcp-check connect
14913 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014914
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014915check-send-proxy
14916 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14917 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14918 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14919 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14920 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14921 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14922 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14923
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014924check-alpn <protocols>
14925 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14926 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14927 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14928
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014929check-proto <name>
14930 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14931 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14932 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014933 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14934 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14935
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014936 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14937 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14938 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014939
14940 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14941 directive on a server line:
14942
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014943 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014944 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14945 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14946 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14947
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014948 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014949 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14950 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14951
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014952check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014953 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014954 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14955 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014956
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014957check-ssl
14958 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14959 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14960 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14961 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014962 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014963 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14964 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014965 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014966 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14967 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014968
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014969check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014970 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014971 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14972 for normal traffic.
14973
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014974ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14976 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14977 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014978 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14979 information and recommendations see e.g.
14980 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14981 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14982 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014983
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014984ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14985 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14986 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14987 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14988 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014989 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14990 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14991 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014993cookie <value>
14994 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14995 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14996 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14997 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14998 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14999 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
15000 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
15001
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015002crl-file <crlfile>
15003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15004 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
15005 to verify server's certificate.
15006
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020015007crt <cert>
15008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15009 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
15010 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
15011 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
15012 certificate request.
15013
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020015014 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
15015 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
15016 option is set accordingly).
15017
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015018disabled
15019 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
15020 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
15021 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
15022 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
15023 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015024 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015025
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015026enabled
15027 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
15028 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
15029 default value.
15030 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
15031 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015032
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015033error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010015034 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
15035 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
15036 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015038 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015040fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015041 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
15042 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
15043 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
15044
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015045force-sslv3
15046 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15047 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015048 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015049 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015050
15051force-tlsv10
15052 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015053 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015054 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015055
15056force-tlsv11
15057 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015058 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015059 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015060
15061force-tlsv12
15062 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015063 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015064 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015065
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015066force-tlsv13
15067 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15068 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015069 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015071id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020015072 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
15073 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
15074 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015075
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015076init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
15077 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
15078 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015079 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015080 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
15081 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
15082 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
15083 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
15084 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
15085 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
15086 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
15087 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
15088 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015089 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015090 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
15091 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
15092 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
15093 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
15094 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
15095 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015096 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015097
15098 Example:
15099 defaults
15100 # never fail on address resolution
15101 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
15102
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015103inter <delay>
15104fastinter <delay>
15105downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015106 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
15107 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15108 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
15109 between checks depending on the server state :
15110
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020015111 Server state | Interval used
15112 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15113 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
15114 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15115 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
15116 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
15117 or yet unchecked. |
15118 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15119 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
15120 | "inter" otherwise.
15121 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015123 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
15124 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
15125 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
15126 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015127 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15128 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15129 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15130 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15131 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015132
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020015133log-proto <logproto>
15134 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
15135 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
15136 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
15137 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
15138
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015139maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015140 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
15141 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015142 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
15143 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015144 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
15145 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
15146 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
15147 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
15148
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015149 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
15150 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
15151 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
15152 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
15153 than 50 concurrent requests.
15154
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015155maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015156 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
15157 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
15158 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
15159 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020015160 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
15161 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
15162 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
15163 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
15164 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
15165 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
15166 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015167
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010015168max-reuse <count>
15169 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
15170 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
15171 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
15172 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
15173 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
15174 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
15175 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
15176 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
15177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015178minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015179 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
15180 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
15181 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
15182 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
15183 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
15184 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015185 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015186 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015187
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015188namespace <name>
15189 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15190 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
15191 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15192 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15193
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015194no-agent-check
15195 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
15196 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15197 default value.
15198 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15199 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
15200
15201no-backup
15202 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
15203 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15204 default value.
15205 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15206 "default-server" "backup" setting.
15207
15208no-check
15209 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
15210 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15211 default value.
15212 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15213 "default-server" "check" setting.
15214
15215no-check-ssl
15216 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
15217 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15218 default value.
15219 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15220 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
15221
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015222no-send-proxy
15223 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
15224 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15225 default value.
15226 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15227 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
15228
15229no-send-proxy-v2
15230 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
15231 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15232 default value.
15233 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15234 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15235
15236no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15237 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15238 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15239 default value.
15240 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15241 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15242
15243no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15244 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15245 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15246 default value.
15247 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15248 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15249
15250no-ssl
15251 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15252 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15253 default value.
15254 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15255 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15256
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015257 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15258 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15259 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15260
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015261no-ssl-reuse
15262 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15263 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15264 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15265 and for paranoid users.
15266
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015267no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015268 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15269 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015270 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015271
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015272 Supported in default-server: No
15273
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015274no-tls-tickets
15275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15276 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15277 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015278 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15279 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015280 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15281 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15282 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015283 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015284
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015285no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015286 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015287 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15288 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015289 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15290 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015291 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015292
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015293 Supported in default-server: No
15294
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015295no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015296 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015297 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15298 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015299 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15300 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015301 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015302
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015303 Supported in default-server: No
15304
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015305no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015306 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015307 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15308 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015309 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15310 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015311 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015312
15313 Supported in default-server: No
15314
15315no-tlsv13
15316 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15317 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15318 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15319 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15320 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015321 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015322
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015323 Supported in default-server: No
15324
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015325no-verifyhost
15326 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15327 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15328 default value.
15329 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15330 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015331
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015332no-tfo
15333 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15334 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15335 default value.
15336 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15337 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15338
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015339non-stick
15340 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15341 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15342 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15343
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015344npn <protocols>
15345 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15346 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15347 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015348 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015349 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15350 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15351 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015353observe <mode>
15354 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15355 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15356 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15357 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15358 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15359 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015360 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015361
15362 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015364on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015365 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15366 Currently, four modes are available:
15367 - fastinter: force fastinter
15368 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15369 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15370 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15371 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15372
15373 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15374
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015375on-marked-down <action>
15376 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15377 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015378 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15379 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15380 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15381 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15382 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15383 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15384 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15385 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015386
15387 Actions are disabled by default
15388
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015389on-marked-up <action>
15390 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15391 Currently one action is available:
15392 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15393 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15394 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15395 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015396 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
15397 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015398 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
15399 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
15400
15401 Actions are disabled by default
15402
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015403pool-low-conn <max>
15404 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15405 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15406 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15407 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15408 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15409 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15410 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15411 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15412 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15413 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015414 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15415 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15416 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15417 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015418
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015419pool-max-conn <max>
15420 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15421 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15422 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15423 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15424 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15425 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15426
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015427pool-purge-delay <delay>
15428 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015429 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015430 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015432port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015433 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015434 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15435 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15436 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15437 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15438 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015439
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015440proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015441 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15442 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15443 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015444 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15445 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15446
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015447 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15448 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15449 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015450
15451 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15452 a server line :
15453
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015454 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015455 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15456 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15457 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15458
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015459 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015460 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15461
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015462 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015464redir <prefix>
15465 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15466 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15467 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15468 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15469 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15470 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15471 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15472 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015473 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015474 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015475 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15476 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15477 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15478 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15479
15480 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015482rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015483 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15484 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15485 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15486
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015487resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15488 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15489 server.
15490
15491 Available options:
15492
15493 * allow-dup-ip
15494 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15495 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15496 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15497 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15498 For such case, simply enable this option.
15499 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15500
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015501 * ignore-weight
15502 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15503 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15504 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15505
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015506 * prevent-dup-ip
15507 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15508 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15509 same fqdn.
15510 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15511
15512 Example:
15513 backend b_myapp
15514 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15515 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15516 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15517
15518 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15519 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15520 it
15521 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15522 different address
15523
15524 Default value: not set
15525
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015526resolve-prefer <family>
15527 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15528 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15529 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15530 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15531
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015532 Default value: ipv6
15533
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015534 Example:
15535
15536 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015537
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015538resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015539 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015540 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015541 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015542 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15543 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015544 configured network, another address is selected.
15545
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015546 Example:
15547
15548 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015549
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015550resolvers <id>
15551 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15552 hostname.
15553
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015554 Example:
15555
15556 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015557
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015558 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015559
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015560send-proxy
15561 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15562 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15563 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15564 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015565 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15566 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15567 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15568 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015569 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015570 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15571 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15572 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15573 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15574 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015575 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15576 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015577
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015578send-proxy-v2
15579 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15580 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15581 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15582 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015583 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15584 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15585 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15586 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015587
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015588proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015589 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15590 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15591
15592 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15593 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15594 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15595 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15596 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15597 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15598 connection is supported).
15599 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15600 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15601 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15602 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15603 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15604 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15605 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015606
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015607send-proxy-v2-ssl
15608 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15609 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15610 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15611 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15612 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15613 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15614 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015615 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15616 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015617
15618send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15619 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15620 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15621 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15622 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15623 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15624 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15625 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15626 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015627 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15628 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015630slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015631 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15632 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15633 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15634 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15635 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15636 parameters :
15637
15638 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15639 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15640
15641 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15642 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15643 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15644 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15645
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015646 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015647 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15648 seen as failed.
15649
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015650sni <expression>
15651 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15652 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15653 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15654 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015655 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15656 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015657 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015658 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15659 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015660
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015661source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015662source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015663source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015664 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15665 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15666 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15667 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15668
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015669 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15670 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15671 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15672 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15673 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15674 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15675 server.
15676
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015677 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15678 specifying the source address without port(s).
15679
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015680ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015681 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15682 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15683 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15684 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15685 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15686 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015687 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15688 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015689
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015690ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15691 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15692 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15693 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15694
15695ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15696 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15697 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15698 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15699
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015700ssl-reuse
15701 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15702 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15703 default value.
15704 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15705 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15706
15707stick
15708 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15709 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15710 default value.
15711 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15712 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015713
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015714socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015715 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015716 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15717 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15718
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015719tcp-ut <delay>
15720 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015721 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015722 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015723 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015724 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15725 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15726 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15727 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15728 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15729 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15730 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15731 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15732 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15733
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015734tfo
15735 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15736 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15737 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15738 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015739 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015740 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015742track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015743 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15744 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15745 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15746 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015747 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15748
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015749tls-tickets
15750 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15751 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15752 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015753 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15754 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15755 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015756 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015757 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015758
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015759verify [none|required]
15760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015761 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015762 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15763 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015764 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015765 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15766 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15767 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15768 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15769 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15770 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15771 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15772 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015773
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015774verifyhost <hostname>
15775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015776 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15777 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15778 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15779 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15780 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15781 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15782 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15783 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015785weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015786 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15787 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15788 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015789 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15790 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15791 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15792 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15793 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15794 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015795
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015796ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15797 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15798 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15799 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15800
15801 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15802 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15803 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15804 server ALPN contains it.
15805
15806 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15807 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15808 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15809 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15810
15811 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15812 favor of the ALPN extension.
15813
15814 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015816
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200158175.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15818-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015819
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015820HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15821using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015822configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015823This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15824can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15825workload.
15826This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15827resolution at run time.
15828Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15829carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15830
15831
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200158325.3.1. Global overview
15833----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015834
15835As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15836different steps of the process life:
15837
15838 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15839 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15840 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15841
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015842 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15843 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015844
15845A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15846 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15847 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15848 resolution to know this new IP.
15849
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015850When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015851HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015852SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15853from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015854will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015855will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015856
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015857A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015858 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015859 first valid response.
15860
15861 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15862 servers return an error.
15863
15864
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200158655.3.2. The resolvers section
15866----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015867
15868This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015869HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15870contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015871
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020015872At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
15873no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
15874default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
15875failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
15876
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015877When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15878uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15879is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15880answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15881
15882When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015883used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015884
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015885 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15886 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15887 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015888
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015889 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15890 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015891
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015892 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015893 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15894 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015895
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015896For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15897following scenarios are possible:
15898
15899 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15900 ignored
15901
15902 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15903 applied
15904
15905 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15906 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15907
15908 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15909 retries the query with a new type
15910
15911 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15912 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015913
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015914As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015915a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015916<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015917
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015918
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015919resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015920 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015921
15922A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15923
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015924accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015925 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015926 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015927 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15928 by RFC 6891)
15929
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015930 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15931 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15932 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15933 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15934 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15935 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015936
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015937nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15938 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15939 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15940 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15941 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15942 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15943 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15944 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15945 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15946 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015947 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15948
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015949parse-resolv-conf
15950 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15951 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15952 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15953
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015954hold <status> <period>
15955 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15956 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015957 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015958 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015959 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15960 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15961 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15962
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015963 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015964
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015965resolve_retries <nb>
15966 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15967 giving up.
15968 Default value: 3
15969
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015970 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15971 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15972 type.
15973
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015974timeout <event> <time>
15975 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15976 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15977 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015978 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15979 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015980 Default value: 1s
15981 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015982 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015983 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015984 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15985 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15986
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015987 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015988
15989 resolvers mydns
15990 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15991 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015992 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015993 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015994 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015995 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015996 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015997 hold other 30s
15998 hold refused 30s
15999 hold nx 30s
16000 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016001 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016002 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016003
16004
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200160056. Cache
16006---------
16007
16008HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
16009(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
16010RAM.
16011
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020016012The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
16013blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016014
16015If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
16016independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
16017when we try to allocate a new one.
16018
16019The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
16020
16021It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
16022"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
16023for more details.
16024
16025When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
16026replaced by "<CACHE>".
16027
16028
160296.1. Limitation
16030----------------
16031
16032The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
16033
16034- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010016035- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
16036 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
16037 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016038- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
16039- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010016040- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
16041 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
16042 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016043- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
16044 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010016045- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
16046 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
16047 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016048
16049- If the request is not a GET
16050- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
16051- If the request contains an Authorization header
16052
16053
160546.2. Setup
16055-----------
16056
16057To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
16058the corresponding http-request and response actions.
16059
16060
160616.2.1. Cache section
16062---------------------
16063
16064cache <name>
16065 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
16066 size of cache is mandatory.
16067
16068total-max-size <megabytes>
16069 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
16070 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
16071
16072max-object-size <bytes>
16073 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
16074 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
16075 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
16076
16077max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016078 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016079 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
16080 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
16081 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
16082 default.
16083
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016084process-vary <on/off>
16085 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016086 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
16087 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
16088 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016089 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016090
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016091max-secondary-entries <number>
16092 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
16093 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
16094 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
16095
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016096
160976.2.2. Proxy section
16098---------------------
16099
16100http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16101 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
16102 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
16103 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
16104 after this one.
16105
16106http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16107 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
16108 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
16109 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
16110 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
16111
16112
16113Example:
16114
16115 backend bck1
16116 mode http
16117
16118 http-request cache-use foobar
16119 http-response cache-store foobar
16120 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
16121
16122 cache foobar
16123 total-max-size 4
16124 max-age 240
16125
16126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161277. Using ACLs and fetching samples
16128----------------------------------
16129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016130HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016131client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
16132The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
16133these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
16134but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
16135data called patterns.
16136
16137
161387.1. ACL basics
16139---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016140
16141The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
16142content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
16143from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
16144simple :
16145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016147 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
16149 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
16152adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016153
16154In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
16155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016157
16158This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
16159Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
16160and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016161an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
16162conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
16163as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
16164are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016165
16166ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
16167'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
16168which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
16169
16170There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
16171performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
16172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016173The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
16174specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
16175this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016176methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
16177ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178
16179Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
16180 - boolean
16181 - integer (signed or unsigned)
16182 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
16183 - string
16184 - data block
16185
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016186Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
16187converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
16188would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
16189The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
16190which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
16191
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016192Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
16193keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
16194fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
16195which are summarized in the table below :
16196
16197 +---------------------+-----------------+
16198 | Sample or converter | Default |
16199 | output type | matching method |
16200 +---------------------+-----------------+
16201 | boolean | bool |
16202 +---------------------+-----------------+
16203 | integer | int |
16204 +---------------------+-----------------+
16205 | ip | ip |
16206 +---------------------+-----------------+
16207 | string | str |
16208 +---------------------+-----------------+
16209 | binary | none, use "-m" |
16210 +---------------------+-----------------+
16211
16212Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
16213matching method, see below.
16214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016215The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
16216 - boolean
16217 - integer or integer range
16218 - IP address / network
16219 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
16220 - regular expression
16221 - hex block
16222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016223The following ACL flags are currently supported :
16224
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016225 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
16226 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016228 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016229 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016230 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016231 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
16232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016233The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16234read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16235if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16236lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16237will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16238beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016239a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16241exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16242
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016243The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16244parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16245ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16246a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16247check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16248
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016249The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16250socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16251file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016253Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16254loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16255
16256 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16257
16258In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16259the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16260case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16261as well.
16262
16263The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16264sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16265do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16266methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16267is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016268obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016269followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16270default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16271that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16272string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16273
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016274The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16275By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16276string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16277resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016278server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016279waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016280flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16281function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016283There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16284sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16285be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016286
16287 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16288 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016289 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16290 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16291 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16292 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016293
16294 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16295 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016296 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016297
16298 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016299 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016300
16301 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016302 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016303
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016304 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016305 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16306
16307 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16308 binary or string samples.
16309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16311 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016313 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16314 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16315 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016317 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16318 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016320 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16321 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16324 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016326 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16327 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016328 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016330 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16331 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16332 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016333
16334For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16335request, it is possible to do :
16336
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016337 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016338
16339In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
16340buffer, one would use the following acl :
16341
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016342 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016343
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016344On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
16345possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
16346
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016347 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
16350criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
16351method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
16352to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
16353criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
16354the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016356If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016357the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
16358For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016360 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
16361 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
16362 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
16363 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016364
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016365
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016366The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
16367types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
16368combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
16369brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
16370default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016372 +-------------------------------------------------+
16373 | Input sample type |
16374 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016375 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016376 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16377 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
16378 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016379 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016380 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016381 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016382 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016383 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016384 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016385 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016387 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016389 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016390 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016391 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016392 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016393 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016394 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016395 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016396 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016397 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016398 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016399 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016400 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16401 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
16402 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016403
16404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200164057.1.1. Matching booleans
16406------------------------
16407
16408In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16409Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16410When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16411that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16412
16413Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16414return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16415"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16416
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200164187.1.2. Matching integers
16419------------------------
16420
16421Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16422enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16423to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16424
16425Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16426matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16427lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016428
16429For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16430unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16431representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16432
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016433As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16434two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16435instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16436ranges and operators.
16437
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016438For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016439operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16440Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16441of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016443Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016444
16445 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16446 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16447 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16448 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16449 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16450
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016451For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016452
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016453 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016454
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016455This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16456
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016457 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016458
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200164607.1.3. Matching strings
16461-----------------------
16462
16463String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16464different forms :
16465
16466 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016467 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016468
16469 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016470 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016471
16472 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16473 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16474
16475 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16476 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16477
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010016478 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
16480 matches.
16481
16482 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
16483 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
16484 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016485
16486String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16487exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16488characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16489string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16490to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016491before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016492
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016493Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16494(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16495Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16496
16497Example:
16498 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16499 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16500
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200165027.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16503---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016504
16505Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16506they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16507possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16508passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16509the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016510the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16511match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016512
16513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200165147.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16515-------------------------------------
16516
16517It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16518not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16519a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16520to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16521digits may be used upper or lower case.
16522
16523Example :
16524 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016525 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016526
16527
165287.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16529---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016530
16531IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16532netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16533within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016534host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016535difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16536at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16537does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16538parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016539
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016540The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16541abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16542
16543 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16544 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16545 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16546 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16547 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16548 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16549 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16550 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16551
16552Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16553192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16554
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016555IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16556Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16557trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16558IPv6 patterns.
16559
16560HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16561following situations :
16562 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16563 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16564 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16565 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16566 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16567 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16568 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16569 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16570 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16571 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016573
165747.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16575----------------------------------
16576
16577Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16578combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16579
16580 - AND (implicit)
16581 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16582 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016584A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016586 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016588Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16589indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016591For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16592"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16593requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16594is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16595
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016596 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016597 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16598 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16599 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600
16601To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16602and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16603
16604 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16605 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16606 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16607 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16608
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016609 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016610 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16611 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16612 use_backend www if host_www
16613
16614It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16615expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16616be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16617the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16618
16619 The following rule :
16620
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016621 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016622 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016623
16624 Can also be written that way :
16625
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016626 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016627
16628It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16629to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16630simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16631sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16632good use is the following :
16633
16634 With named ACLs :
16635
16636 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16637 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16638 monitor fail if site_dead
16639
16640 With anonymous ACLs :
16641
16642 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16643
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016644See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16645keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016646
16647
166487.3. Fetching samples
16649---------------------
16650
16651Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16652against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16653sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16654ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16655of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16656available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16657
16658This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16659Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16660compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16661deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16662
16663The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16664matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16665method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16666indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16667
16668As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16669when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16670mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16671the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16672ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16673
16674Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16675multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16676when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016677incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16678are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016679is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16680all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16681
16682Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16683 - name
16684 - name(arg1)
16685 - name(arg1,arg2)
16686
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016687
166887.3.1. Converters
16689-----------------
16690
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016691Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16692of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16693is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16694was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016695has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016696unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16697
16698These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16699sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16700the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016701support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016702
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016703A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16704support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16705supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16706(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16707bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016709The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016710
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001671151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16712 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16713 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16714 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16715 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16716 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16717
16718 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016719 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16720 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016721 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16722 frontend http-in
16723 bind *:8081
16724 default_backend servers
16725 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16726 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16727
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016728add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016729 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016730 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016731 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16732 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016733 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016734 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16735 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16736 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16737 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016738 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016739 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016740
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020016741add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
16742 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
16743 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
16744 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
16745 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
16746 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16747 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
16748 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
16749 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
16750 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
16751 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
16752 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
16753 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
16754 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
16755 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
16756 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
16757 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
16758 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16759 level parser. See examples below.
16760
16761 Example:
16762 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
16763 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
16764 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
16765 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
16766
16767 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
16768 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
16769
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016770aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16771 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16772 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16773 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16774 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16775 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16776 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16777
16778 Example:
16779 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16780 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16781
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016782and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016783 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016784 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016785 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16786 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016787 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016788 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16789 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16790 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16791 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016792 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016793 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016794
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016795b64dec
16796 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16797 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016798 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16799 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016800
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016801base64
16802 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016803 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016804 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16805 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016806
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016807be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16808 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16809 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16810 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16811 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16812 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16813
16814 Example:
16815 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16816 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16817 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16818 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16819
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016820be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16821 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16822 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16823 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16824 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16825 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16826 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16827
16828 Example:
16829 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16830 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16831 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16832 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16833
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016834bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016835 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016836 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016837 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016838 presence of a flag).
16839
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016840bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16841 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16842 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016843 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016844
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016845concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16846 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16847 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16848 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16849 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16850 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16851 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16852 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16853 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16854 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16855 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016856 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016857 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016858 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016859 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16860 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16861 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016862
16863 Example:
16864 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16865 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16866 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016867 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016868 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016869 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16870
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016871cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016872 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16873 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016874
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016875crc32([<avalanche>])
16876 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16877 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16878 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16879 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16880 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16881 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16882 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16883 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16884 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16885 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016886 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16887
16888crc32c([<avalanche>])
16889 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16890 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16891 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16892 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16893 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16894 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16895 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16896 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016897
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016898cut_crlf
16899 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16900 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16901 updated.
16902
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016903da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016904 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16905 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16906 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16907 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016908 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016909 configuration language.
16910
16911 Example:
16912 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016913 bind *:8881
16914 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016915 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016916
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016917debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16918 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16919 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16920 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16921 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16922 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16923 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16924 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16925 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16926 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16927 printable sample types.
16928
16929 Example:
16930 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016931
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016932digest(<algorithm>)
16933 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16934 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16935
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016936 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016937 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16938
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016939div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016940 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16941 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016942 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016943 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16944 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016945 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016946 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16947 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16948 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16949 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016950 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016951 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016952
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016953djb2([<avalanche>])
16954 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16955 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16956 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16957 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16958 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16959 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16960 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016961 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16962 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016963
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016964even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016965 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016966 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16967
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016968field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16969 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16970 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16971 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16972 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16973 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16974 fields.
16975
16976 Example :
16977 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16978 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16979 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16980 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16981 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016982
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016983fix_is_valid
16984 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16985 Information eXchange):
16986
16987 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16988 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016989 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016990 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016991 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016992 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16993 checksum
16994
16995 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16996 the server can be parsed.
16997
16998 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16999 message, false if not.
17000
17001 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
17002
17003 Example:
17004 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17005 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17006
17007fix_tag_value(<tag>)
17008 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
17009 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
17010 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
17011 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050017012 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017013 added.
17014
17015 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17016 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
17017 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
17018 fix_is_valid converter.
17019
17020 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
17021
17022 Example:
17023 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17024 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17025 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
17026 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
17027 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
17028
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017029hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017030 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017031 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017032 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017033 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010017034
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017035hex2i
17036 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017037 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017038
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020017039htonl
17040 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
17041 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
17042 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
17043 unsigned 32-bit integer.
17044
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017045hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017046 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
17047 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
17048 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
17049 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
17050
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017051 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017052 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17053
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017054http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017055 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17056 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017057 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
17058 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
17059 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
17060 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
17061 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
17062 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
17063 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
17064 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017065
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017066iif(<true>,<false>)
17067 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
17068 string otherwise.
17069
17070 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020017071 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017072
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017073in_table(<table>)
17074 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17075 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
17076 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017077 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017078 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
17079
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017080ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017081 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017082 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017083 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
17084 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
17085 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
17086 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
17087 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017088
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017089json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017090 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017091 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017092 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017093 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
17094 of errors:
17095 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
17096 bytes, ...)
17097 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
17098 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
17099
17100 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
17101 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
17102 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
17103 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
17104 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
17105 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017106 - "ascii" : never fails;
17107 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
17108 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017109 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017110 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017111 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
17112 characters corresponding to the other errors.
17113
17114 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017115 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017116
17117 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017118 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017119 capture request header user-agent len 150
17120 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017121
17122 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
17123 GET / HTTP/1.0
17124 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
17125
17126 Output log:
17127 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
17128
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020017129json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
17130 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
17131 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
17132 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
17133 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
17134
17135 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
17136 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
17137
17138 Example:
17139 # get a integer value from the request body
17140 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
17141 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
17142
17143 # get a key with '.' in the name
17144 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
17145 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
17146
17147 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
17148 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
17149
17150 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
17151 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
17152
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020017153jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17154 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
17155 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
17156 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
17157 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17158 json_path and output_type parameters.
17159
17160 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17161 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17162
17163jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17164 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
17165 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
17166 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
17167 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17168 json_path and output_type parameters.
17169
17170 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17171 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17172
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017173jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
17174 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
17175 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017176 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017177 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
17178 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
17179 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
17180 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017181
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017182 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
17183 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
17184 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
17185 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017186
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017187 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
17188 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
17189 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
17190 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
17191 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
17192 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017193 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017194 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
17195
17196 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
17197 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
17198 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
17199 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
17200 contents.
17201
17202 The possible return values are the following :
17203
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017204 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
17205 | ID | message |
17206 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017207 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017208 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017209 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
17210 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
17211 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
17212 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
17213 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017214 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017215
17216 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17217 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17218
17219 Example:
17220 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
17221 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
17222 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
17223 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
17224 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
17225 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
17226
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017227language(<value>[,<default>])
17228 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
17229 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
17230 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
17231 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
17232 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17233 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
17234 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
17235 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
17236 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017237 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017238 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
17239 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017240
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017241 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017242
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017243 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
17244 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017245
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017246 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
17247 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
17248 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
17249 use_backend spanish if es
17250 use_backend french if fr
17251 use_backend english if en
17252 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017253
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010017254length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010017255 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
17256 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17257 type. The result is of type integer.
17258
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017259lower
17260 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
17261 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17262 type. The result is of type string.
17263
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017264ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
17265 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17266 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
17267 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17268 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17269 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17270 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
17271
17272 Example :
17273
17274 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017275 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017276 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17277
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020017278ltrim(<chars>)
17279 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
17280 representation of the input sample.
17281
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017282map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17283map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17284map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17285 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
17286 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
17287 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
17288 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
17289 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
17290 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
17291 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
17292 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017293
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017294 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
17295 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
17296 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017297
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017298 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017299 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017300
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017301 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
17302 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17303 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
17304 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020017305 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
17306 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017307 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
17308 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17309 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
17310 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17311 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
17312 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17313 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
17314 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080017315 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
17316 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17317 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017318 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17319 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
17320 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17321 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
17322 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017323
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010017324 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
17325 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
17326 the corresponding match text.
17327
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017328 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
17329 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
17330 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
17331 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
17332 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017333
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017334 Example :
17335
17336 # this is a comment and is ignored
17337 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
17338 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
17339 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
17340 | | | `---------- value
17341 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
17342 | `---------------------------- key
17343 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
17344
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017345mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017346 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17347 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017348 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017349 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017350 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017351 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17352 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17353 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17354 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017355 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017356 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017357
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017358mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017359 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
17360 <packettype>.
17361 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
17362 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
17363 from.
17364 Supported string and integers can be found here:
17365 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
17366 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
17367
17368 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
17369 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
17370 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
17371 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
17372
17373 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
17374 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
17375 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17376 packets only):
17377 17: Session Expiry Interval
17378 33: Receive Maximum
17379 39: Maximum Packet Size
17380 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17381 25: Request Response Information
17382 23: Request Problem Information
17383 21: Authentication Method
17384 22: Authentication Data
17385 18: Will Delay Interval
17386 1: Payload Format Indicator
17387 2: Message Expiry Interval
17388 3: Content Type
17389 8: Response Topic
17390 9: Correlation Data
17391 Not supported yet:
17392 38: User Property
17393
17394 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
17395 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17396 packets only):
17397 17: Session Expiry Interval
17398 33: Receive Maximum
17399 36: Maximum QoS
17400 37: Retain Available
17401 39: Maximum Packet Size
17402 18: Assigned Client Identifier
17403 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17404 31: Reason String
17405 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
17406 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
17407 42: Shared Subscription Available
17408 19: Server Keep Alive
17409 26: Response Information
17410 28: Server Reference
17411 21: Authentication Method
17412 22: Authentication Data
17413 Not supported yet:
17414 38: User Property
17415
17416 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17417 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17418 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17419 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17420
17421 Example:
17422
17423 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
17424 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17425 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
17426 if data_in_buffer
17427 # do the same as above
17428 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17429 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
17430 if data_in_buffer
17431
17432mqtt_is_valid
17433 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
17434
17435 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17436 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17437 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17438 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17439
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010017440 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
17441
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017442 Example:
17443
17444 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040017445 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017446
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017447mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017448 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020017449 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
17450 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017451 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017452 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017453 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017454 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17455 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17456 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17457 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017458 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017459 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017460
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010017461nbsrv
17462 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
17463 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
17464 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
17465 map lookup.
17466
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017467neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017468 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
17469 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
17470 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
17471 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017472
17473not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017474 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017475 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017476 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017477 absence of a flag).
17478
17479odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017480 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017481 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
17482
17483or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017484 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017485 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017486 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17487 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017488 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017489 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17490 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17491 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17492 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017493 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017494 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017495
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017496protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
17497 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
17498 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
17499 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
17500 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
17501 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17502 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17503 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17504 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
17505 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
17506 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17507 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
17508
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010017509regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017510 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
17511 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
17512 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
17513 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
17514 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
17515 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
17516 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
17517 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
17518 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017519 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17520 of characters with other ones.
17521
17522 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17523 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17524 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17525 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17526 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17527 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017528
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017529 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017530
17531 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17532 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17533 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017534 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017535
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017536 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17537 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17538
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017539 # capture groups and backreferences
17540 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017541 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017542 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17543
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017544capture-req(<id>)
17545 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17546 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17547
17548 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017549 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17550 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017551
17552capture-res(<id>)
17553 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17554 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17555
17556 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017557 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17558 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017559
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017560rtrim(<chars>)
17561 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17562 of the input sample.
17563
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017564sdbm([<avalanche>])
17565 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17566 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17567 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17568 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17569 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17570 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17571 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017572 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17573 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017574
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017575secure_memcmp(<var>)
17576 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17577 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17578 match.
17579
17580 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17581 performed in constant time.
17582
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017583 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017584 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17585
17586 Example :
17587
17588 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17589 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17590 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17591 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17592
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017593set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017594 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017595 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
17596 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
17597 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17598 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017599 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017600 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17601 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017602 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017603 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17604 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017605 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017606 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017607
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017608 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
17609 possible conditions :
17610 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
17611 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
17612 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
17613 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
17614 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
17615 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
17616 Checks if the input is empty or not.
17617 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
17618 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
17619 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
17620 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
17621 called on the variable.
17622 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
17623 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
17624 configuration parsing.
17625 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
17626 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
17627 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
17628 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
17629 true by default.
17630
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017631sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017632 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017633 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17634
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017635sha2([<bits>])
17636 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17637 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17638
17639 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17640 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17641
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017642 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017643 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17644
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017645srv_queue
17646 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17647 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17648 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17649 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17650 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17651
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017652strcmp(<var>)
17653 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17654 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17655 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17656 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17657 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17658 shorter).
17659
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017660 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17661 strings in constant time.
17662
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017663 Example :
17664
17665 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17666 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17667 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17668
17669
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017670sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017671 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17672 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017673 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017674 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17675 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017676 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017677 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17678 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017679 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017680 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17681 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017682 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017683 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017684
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017685table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17686 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17687 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17688 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17689 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17690 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17691 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17692
17693
17694table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17695 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17696 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17697 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17698 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17699 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17700 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17701
17702table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17703 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17704 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017705 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017706 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17707 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17708
17709table_conn_cur(<table>)
17710 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17711 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17712 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17713 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17714 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17715
17716table_conn_rate(<table>)
17717 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17718 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17719 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17720 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17721 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17722
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020017723table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
17724 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
17725 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
17726 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
17727 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
17728 input sample in the designated table.
17729 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
17730
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017731table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17732 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17733 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17734 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17735 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17736 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17737 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17738 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17739 data-type).
17740 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17741
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017742table_gpt0(<table>)
17743 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17744 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17745 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17746 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17747 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17748
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017749table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17750 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17751 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17752 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17753 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17754 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17755 between 0 and 99.
17756 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17757 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17758 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17759 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17760
17761table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17762 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17763 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17764 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17765 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17766 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17767 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17768 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17769 value 0.
17770 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17771 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17772 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17773
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017774table_gpc0(<table>)
17775 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17776 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17777 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17778 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17779 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17780
17781table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17782 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17783 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17784 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17785 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17786 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17787 sample fetch keyword.
17788
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017789table_gpc1(<table>)
17790 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17791 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17792 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17793 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17794 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17795
17796table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17797 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17798 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17799 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17800 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17801 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17802 sample fetch keyword.
17803
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017804table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17805 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17806 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017807 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017808 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17809 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17810
17811table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17812 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17813 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17814 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17815 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17816 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17817 keyword.
17818
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017819table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17820 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17821 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17822 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17823 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17824 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17825
17826table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17827 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17828 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17829 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17830 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17831 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17832 keyword.
17833
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017834table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17835 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17836 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017837 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017838 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17839 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17840
17841table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17842 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17843 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17844 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17845 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17846 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17847 keyword.
17848
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020017849table_idle(<table>)
17850 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
17851 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
17852 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
17853 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
17854 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
17855 updated.
17856 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
17857
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017858table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17859 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17860 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017861 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017862 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17863 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17864 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17865 keyword.
17866
17867table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17868 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17869 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017870 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017871 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17872 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17873 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17874 keyword.
17875
17876table_server_id(<table>)
17877 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17878 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17879 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17880 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17881 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17882 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17883
17884table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17885 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17886 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017887 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017888 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17889 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17890 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17891 keyword.
17892
17893table_sess_rate(<table>)
17894 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17895 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17896 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17897 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17898 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17899 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17900 keyword.
17901
17902table_trackers(<table>)
17903 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17904 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17905 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17906 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17907 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17908 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17909 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17910 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17911 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17912 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17913
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017914ub64dec
17915 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17916 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17917 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17918
17919 Example:
17920 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17921 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17922
17923ub64enc
17924 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17925
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017926upper
17927 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17928 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17929 type. The result is of type string.
17930
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017931url_dec([<in_form>])
17932 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17933 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17934 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17935 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17936 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17937 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017938
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017939url_enc([<enc_type>])
17940 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17941 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17942 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17943 optional argument is here for future changes.
17944
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017945ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017946 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017947 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17948 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17949 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017950 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17951 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17952 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17953 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017954 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017955 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17956 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017957
17958 Example:
17959 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17960 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17961
17962 message Point {
17963 int32 latitude = 1;
17964 int32 longitude = 2;
17965 }
17966
17967 message PPoint {
17968 Point point = 59;
17969 }
17970
17971 message Rectangle {
17972 // One corner of the rectangle.
17973 PPoint lo = 48;
17974 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17975 PPoint hi = 49;
17976 }
17977
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017978 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17979 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17980 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017981
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017982 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17983 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017984 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017985 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17986
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017987 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017988
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017989 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017990
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017991 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17992 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17993 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017994
17995 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17996 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17997 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17998
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017999 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
18000 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
18001 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018002
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018003
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010018004unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010018005 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
18006 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
18007 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
18008 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18009 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
18010 response),
18011 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18012 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
18013 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
18014 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
18015
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018016utime(<format>[,<offset>])
18017 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18018 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
18019 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18020 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18021 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18022 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
18023
18024 Example :
18025
18026 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018027 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018028 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18029
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018030word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18031 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
18032 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
18033 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018034 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018035 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
18036 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
18037
18038 Example :
18039 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
18040 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18041 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
18042 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
18043 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018044 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010018045
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018046wt6([<avalanche>])
18047 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
18048 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18049 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18050 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18051 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18052 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18053 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018054 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
18055 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018056
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018057xor(<value>)
18058 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018059 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018060 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018061 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018062 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018063 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18064 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018065 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018066 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18067 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018068 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018069 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018070
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010018071xxh3([<seed>])
18072 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
18073 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
18074 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
18075 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
18076 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
18077 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
18078 considered as cryptographically secure.
18079
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010018080xxh32([<seed>])
18081 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
18082 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18083 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18084 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18085 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18086 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18087 as cryptographically secure.
18088
18089xxh64([<seed>])
18090 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
18091 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18092 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18093 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18094 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18095 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18096 as cryptographically secure.
18097
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018098
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180997.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018100--------------------------------------------
18101
18102A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
18103not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
18104"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
18105The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
18106
18107always_false : boolean
18108 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18109 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18110
18111always_true : boolean
18112 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18113 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18114
18115avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018116 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018117 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
18118 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
18119 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
18120 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
18121 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
18122 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
18123 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
18124 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
18125 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
18126 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
18127 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
18128 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
18129 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010018130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018131be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018132 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
18133 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
18134 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
18135 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018136 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
18137
18138be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
18139 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18140 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
18141 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
18142 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
18143 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018144 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
18145 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018146
18147 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
18148 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
18149 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018151be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
18152 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18153 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18154 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018155 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018156 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
18157 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018158
18159 Example :
18160 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
18161 backend dynamic
18162 mode http
18163 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
18164 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018165
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018166bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018167 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
18168 of the string.
18169
18170bool(<bool>) : bool
18171 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
18172 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
18173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018174connslots([<backend>]) : integer
18175 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018176 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018177 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
18178 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050018179
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018180 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018181 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018182 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
18183
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018184 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
18185 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018186
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018187 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018188 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018189 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018190 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018191 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018192 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018193 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018194
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018195 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
18196 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018197 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018198 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018199
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018200cpu_calls : integer
18201 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
18202 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
18203 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
18204 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
18205 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
18206 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
18207
18208cpu_ns_avg : integer
18209 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18210 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18211 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18212 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18213 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18214 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18215 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
18216 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
18217 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
18218 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
18219 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
18220
18221cpu_ns_tot : integer
18222 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18223 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18224 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18225 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18226 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18227 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18228 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
18229 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
18230 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
18231 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
18232 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
18233 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
18234 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
18235
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018236date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018237 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018238
18239 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
18240 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
18241 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018242 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
18243
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018244 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
18245 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
18246 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
18247 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
18248 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
18249
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018250 Example :
18251
18252 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
18253 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018254
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018255 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
18256 # millisecond granularity
18257 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
18258
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010018259date_us : integer
18260 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
18261 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
18262 from the same timeval structure.
18263
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018264env(<name>) : string
18265 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
18266 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
18267 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
18268 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
18269 certain way.
18270
18271 Examples :
18272 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
18273 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
18274
18275 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018276 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018278fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
18279 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018280 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
18281 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018282 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
18283 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018284 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
18286 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018287
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020018288fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18289 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
18290 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
18291 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
18292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018293fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18294 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18295 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18296 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
18297 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
18298 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
18299 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
18300 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
18301 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018302
18303 Example :
18304 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
18305 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
18306 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
18307 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
18308 frontend mail
18309 bind :25
18310 mode tcp
18311 maxconn 100
18312 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
18313 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
18314 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
18315 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018316
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010018317hostname : string
18318 Returns the system hostname.
18319
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018320int(<integer>) : signed integer
18321 Returns a signed integer.
18322
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018323ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
18324 Returns an ipv4.
18325
18326ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
18327 Returns an ipv6.
18328
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018329last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018330 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
18331 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
18332 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18333 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18334 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18335 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18336 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18337 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18338 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18339 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18340 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18341 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
18342
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018343last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018344 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
18345 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
18346 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18347 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18348 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18349 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18350 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18351 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18352 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18353 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18354 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18355 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
18356
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018357lat_ns_avg : integer
18358 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18359 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18360 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18361 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18362 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18363 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18364 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18365 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18366 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018367 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18368 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18369 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18370 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18371 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
18372 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018373
18374lat_ns_tot : integer
18375 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18376 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18377 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18378 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18379 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18380 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18381 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18382 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18383 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018384 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18385 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18386 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18387 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18388 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018389 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
18390 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
18391 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
18392 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
18393 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
18394 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
18395
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018396meth(<method>) : method
18397 Returns a method.
18398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018399nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
18400 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
18401 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
18402 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018403 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
18404 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
18405 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018406
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040018407prio_class : integer
18408 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
18409 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
18410 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
18411
18412prio_offset : integer
18413 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
18414 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
18415 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
18416 set-priority-offset".
18417
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018418proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020018419 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
18420 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018422queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018423 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
18424 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
18425 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018426 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
18427 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
18428 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
18429 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
18430 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
18431
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010018432rand([<range>]) : integer
18433 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
18434 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
18435 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
18436 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
18437 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
18438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018439srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18440 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18441 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
18442 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
18443 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
18444 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018445 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
18446 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
18447
18448srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18449 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18450 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
18451 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18452 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
18453 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
18454 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
18455 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
18456
18457 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
18458 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018459
18460srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
18461 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
18462 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
18463 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018464 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018465 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
18466 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
18467 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
18468
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020018469srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18470 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
18471 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18472 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
18473 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
18474 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
18475 fetch methods.
18476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018477srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18478 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18479 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018480 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018481 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
18482 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018483 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018484 overloading servers).
18485
18486 Example :
18487 # Redirect to a separate back
18488 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
18489 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
18490 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
18491
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018492srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018493 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
18494 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
18495 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
18496
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018497srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018498 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
18499 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18500 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
18501
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018502srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018503 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
18504 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18505 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
18506
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018507stopping : boolean
18508 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
18509 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
18510 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
18511
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018512str(<string>) : string
18513 Returns a string.
18514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018515table_avl([<table>]) : integer
18516 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
18517 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
18518
18519table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18520 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
18521 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
18522 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
18523
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010018524thread : integer
18525 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
18526 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
18527 and debugging purposes.
18528
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020018529uuid([<version>]) : string
18530 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
18531 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
18532 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
18533
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018534var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018535 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018536 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
18537 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
18538 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018539 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018540 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18541 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018542 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018543 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18544 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018545 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018546 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018547
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185487.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018549----------------------------------
18550
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018551The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018552closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
18553methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
18554sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
18555TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018556the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
18557counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020018558"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
18559used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
18560can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
18561Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
18562table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
18563tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
18564currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018565
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018566bc_dst : ip
18567 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18568 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18569 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18570 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18571
18572bc_dst_port : integer
18573 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018574 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018575
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018576bc_err : integer
18577 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18578 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18579 and their corresponding error message.
18580
18581bc_err_str : string
18582 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18583 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18584 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18585 corresponding error message.
18586
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018587bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018588 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18589 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18590 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18591
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018592bc_src : ip
18593 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018594 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018595 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18596 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18597
18598bc_src_port : integer
18599 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018600 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018602be_id : integer
18603 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018604 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18605 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018606
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018607be_name : string
18608 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018609 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18610 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018611
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018612be_server_timeout : integer
18613 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18614 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18615 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18616
18617be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18618 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18619 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18620 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18621
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018622cur_server_timeout : integer
18623 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18624 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18625 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18626
18627cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18628 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18629 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18630 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018632dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018633 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
18634 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
18635 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
18636 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
18637 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
18638 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18639 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18640 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18641 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18642 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18643 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018644
18645dst_conn : integer
18646 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18647 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18648 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18649 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18650 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18651 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18652 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18653 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018654
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018655dst_is_local : boolean
18656 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18657 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18658 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18659 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018660 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018661 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18662 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18663 it only once per connection.
18664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665dst_port : integer
18666 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18667 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018668 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
18669 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
18670 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
18671 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018672
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018673fc_dst : ip
18674 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18675 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
18676 for details.
18677
18678fc_dst_is_local : boolean
18679 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
18680 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
18681 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
18682
18683fc_dst_port : integer
18684 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
18685 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
18686 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
18687
18688fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018689 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
18690 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
18691 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018692 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018693 error codes and their corresponding error message.
18694
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018695fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018696 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018697 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018698 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018699 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
18700
18701 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18702 | ID | message |
18703 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18704 | 0 | "Success" |
18705 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
18706 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
18707 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
18708 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
18709 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
18710 | 6 | "General socket error" |
18711 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
18712 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
18713 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
18714 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18715 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18716 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18717 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18718 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18719 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18720 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18721 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18722 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18723 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18724 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18725 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18726 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18727 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18728 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18729 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18730 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18731 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18732 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18733 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18734 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18735 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18736 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18737 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18738 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18739 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18740 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18741 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18742 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18743 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18744 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18745 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18746 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020018747 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018748 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18749
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018750fc_fackets : integer
18751 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18752 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18753 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18754 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18755
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018756fc_http_major : integer
18757 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18758 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18759 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18760
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018761fc_lost : integer
18762 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18763 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18764 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18765 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18766
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018767fc_pp_authority : string
18768 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18769 if any.
18770
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018771fc_pp_unique_id : string
18772 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18773 if any.
18774
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018775fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18776 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18777 header.
18778
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018779fc_reordering : integer
18780 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18781 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18782 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18783 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18784
18785fc_retrans : integer
18786 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18787 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18788 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18789 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18790
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018791fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18792 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18793 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18794 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18795 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18796 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18797 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18798
18799fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18800 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18801 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18802 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18803 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18804 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18805 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18806
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018807fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018808 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18809 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18810 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18811 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18812
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018813fc_src : ip
18814 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18815 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
18816 for details.
18817
18818fc_src_is_local : boolean
18819 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
18820 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
18821 "src_is_local" for details.
18822
18823fc_src_port : integer
18824
18825 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18826 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
18827 this address. See "src-port" for details.
18828
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018829
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018830fc_unacked : integer
18831 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18832 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18833 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18834 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018835
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018836fe_defbe : string
18837 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18838 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018840fe_id : integer
18841 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018842 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18844
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018845fe_name : string
18846 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18847 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18848 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18849
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018850fe_client_timeout : integer
18851 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18852 current frontend.
18853
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018854sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018855sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18856sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18857sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018858 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18859 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18860 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18861
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018862sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018863sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18864sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18865sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018866 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18867 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18868 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18869
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018870sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18871 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18872 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18873 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18874 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18875 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18876 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18877 will always return zero.
18878 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18879 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18880
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018881sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018882sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18883sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18884sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018885 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18886 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018887 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18888 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18889 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018890
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018891 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018892 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18893 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018894 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18895 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18896 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018897 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18898 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18899
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018900sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18901sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18902sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18903sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18904 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18905 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18906 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18907 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18908 when a first ACL was verified.
18909
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018910sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018911sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18912sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18913sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018914 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018915 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18916
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018917sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018918sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18919sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18920sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018921 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18922 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18923 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18924
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018925sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018926sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18927sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18928sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018929 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18930 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18931 See also src_conn_rate.
18932
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018933sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18934 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18935 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18936 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18937 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18938 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18939 index, zero is returned.
18940 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18941 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18942
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018943sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018944sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18945sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18946sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018947 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018948 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018949
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018950sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18951sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18952sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18953sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18954 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18955 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18956
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018957sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18958 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18959 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18960 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18961 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18962 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18963 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18964 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18965
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018966sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18967sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18968sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18969sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18970 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18971 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18972
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018973sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18974 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18975 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18976 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18977 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18978 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18979 between 0 and 2.
18980 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18981 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18982 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18983 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18984 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18985
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018986sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018987sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18988sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18989sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018990 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18991 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18992 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018993 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18994 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18995 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018996
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018997sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18998sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18999sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19000sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19001 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19002 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19003 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19004 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19005 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19006 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19007
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019008sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019009sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19010sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19011sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019012 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019013 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
19014 See also src_http_err_cnt.
19015
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019016sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019017sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19018sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19019sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019020 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
19021 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19022 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
19023 src_http_err_rate.
19024
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019025sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19026sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19027sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19028sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19029 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
19030 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
19031 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
19032
19033sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19034sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19035sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19036sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19037 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
19038 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
19039 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
19040 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
19041
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019042sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019043sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19044sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19045sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019046 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019047 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19048 src_http_req_cnt.
19049
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019050sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019051sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19052sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19053sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019054 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
19055 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
19056 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19057 src_http_req_rate.
19058
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019059sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19060 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19061 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19062 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19063 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19064 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19065 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19066 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
19067 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19068 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19069
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019070sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019071sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19072sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19073sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019074 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019075 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19076 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19077 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19078 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019079
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019080 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019081 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19082 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019083 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19084
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019085sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19086sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19087sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19088sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19089 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
19090 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19091 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19092 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19093 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
19094
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019095sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019096sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19097sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19098sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019099 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
19100 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19101 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019102
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019103sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019104sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19105sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19106sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019107 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
19108 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19109 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019110
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019111sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019112sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19113sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19114sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019115 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019116 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
19117 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
19118 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019119 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019120 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
19121
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019122sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019123sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19124sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19125sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019126 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
19127 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19128 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
19129 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
19130 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019131 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019132
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019133sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019134sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19135sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19136sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020019137 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
19138 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
19139 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
19140
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019141sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019142sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19143sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19144sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019145 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19146 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019147 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019148 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
19149 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019150 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
19151 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
19152 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019154so_id : integer
19155 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
19156 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
19157 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019158
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010019159so_name : string
19160 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
19161 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
19162 strings instead of integers.
19163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019164src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019165 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
19166 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
19167 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19168 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
19169 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
19170 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
19171 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
19172 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
19173 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
19174 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
19175 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
19176 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
19177 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
19178 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
19179 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019180
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019181 Example:
19182 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
19183 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
19184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019185src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19186 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
19187 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
19188 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019189 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019191src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19192 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
19193 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019194 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019195 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019196
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019197src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19198 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19199 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19200 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
19201 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19202 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
19203 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19204 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19205 See also sc_clr_gpc.
19206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019207src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19208 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19209 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19210 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19211 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19212 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19213 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019214
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019215 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019216 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19217 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
19218 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
19219 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019220 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019221 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19222 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19223
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019224src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19225 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19226 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19227 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19228 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19229 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19230 was verified.
19231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019232src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019233 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019234 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019235 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019236 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019238src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019239 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019240 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19241 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019242 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019244src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19245 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
19246 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19247 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019248 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019249
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019250src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19251 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
19252 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19253 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19254 is an integer between 0 and 99.
19255 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
19256 is returned.
19257 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
19258 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19259 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
19260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019261src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019262 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019263 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019264 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019265 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019266
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019267src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19268 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19269 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19270 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19271 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
19272
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019273src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19274 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19275 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19276 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
19277 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19278 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
19279 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19280
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019281src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19282 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19283 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19284 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19285 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
19286
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019287src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19288 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19289 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
19290 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19291 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
19292 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19293 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
19294 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19295 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19296 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19297 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019299src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019300 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019301 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019302 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19303 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019304 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19305 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19306 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019307
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019308src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19309 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19310 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19311 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19312 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19313 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19314 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19315 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019317src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019318 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019319 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019320 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019321 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019322 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019324src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19325 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
19326 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19327 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19328 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019329 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019330
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019331src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19332 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
19333 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050019334 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019335 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
19336 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19337
19338src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19339 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
19340 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19341 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
19342 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
19343 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
19344 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
19345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019346src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019347 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019348 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19349 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019350 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019352src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19353 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
19354 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19355 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019356 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019357 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019358
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019359src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19360 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
19361 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19362 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
19363 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19364 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
19365 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19366 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19367 See also sc_inc_gpc.
19368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019369src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19370 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19371 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19372 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019373 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019374 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19375 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019376
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019377 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019378 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019379 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019380 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019381
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019382src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19383 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19384 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19385 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
19386 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19387 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19388 connection when a first ACL was verified.
19389
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019390src_is_local : boolean
19391 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
19392 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
19393 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
19394 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019395 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019396 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
19397 once per connection.
19398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019399src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019400 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
19401 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19402 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
19403 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
19404 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019406src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019407 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
19408 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19409 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
19410 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
19411 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019413src_port : integer
19414 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019415 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
19416 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
19417 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
19418 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019420src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019421 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019422 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19423 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
19424 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019425 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019427src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19428 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
19429 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19430 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19431 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019432 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019434src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19435 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
19436 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
19437 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
19438 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
19439 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
19440 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
19441 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
19442 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019443
19444 Example :
19445 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
19446 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
19447 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
19448 listen ssh
19449 bind :22
19450 mode tcp
19451 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019452 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019453 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019454 server local 127.0.0.1:22
19455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019456srv_id : integer
19457 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
19458 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019459 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020019460
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019461srv_name : string
19462 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
19463 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019464 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019465
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200194667.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019467----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020019468
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019469The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019470closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
19471when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
19472usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019473future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019474
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001947551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
19476 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
19477 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
19478 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
19479 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
19480 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
19481
19482 Example :
19483 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
19484 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
19485 # the request.
19486 frontend http-in
19487 bind *:8081
19488 default_backend servers
19489 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
19490 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
19491
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019492ssl_bc : boolean
19493 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19494 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019495 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19496 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019497
19498ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
19499 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019500 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19501 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019502
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019503ssl_bc_alpn : string
19504 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
19505 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019506 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019507 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19508 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19509 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
19510 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
19511 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019512 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
19513 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019514
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019515ssl_bc_cipher : string
19516 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019517 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19518 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019519
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019520ssl_bc_client_random : binary
19521 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19522 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19523 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019524 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019525
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019526ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019527 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019528 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19529 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
19530 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
19531 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019532 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
19533 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
19534 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19535
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019536ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019537 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019538 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19539 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
19540 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019541
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019542ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
19543 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19544 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019545 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19546 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019547
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019548ssl_bc_npn : string
19549 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
19550 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019551 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019552 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
19553 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
19554 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
19555 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019556 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
19557 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019558
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019559ssl_bc_protocol : string
19560 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019561 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19562 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019563
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019564ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019565 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019566 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019567 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
19568 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019569
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019570ssl_bc_server_random : binary
19571 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19572 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19573 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019574 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019575
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019576ssl_bc_session_id : binary
19577 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
19578 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019579 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19580 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019581
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019582ssl_bc_session_key : binary
19583 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19584 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19585 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019586 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019587
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019588ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19589 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019590 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19591 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019593ssl_c_ca_err : integer
19594 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19595 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
19596 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
19597 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19598 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019600ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19601 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19602 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19603 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19604 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019605
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019606ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019607 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19608 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19609 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019610 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019611 does not support resumed sessions.
19612
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019613ssl_c_der : binary
19614 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19615 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19616 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019618ssl_c_err : integer
19619 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19620 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19621 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19622 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19623 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019624
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019625ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019626 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19627 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19628 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19629 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19630 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19631 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19632 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19633 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019634 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19635 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19636 LDAP v3.
19637 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19638 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019640ssl_c_key_alg : string
19641 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19642 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19643 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019645ssl_c_notafter : string
19646 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19647 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19648 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019650ssl_c_notbefore : string
19651 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19652 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19653 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019654
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019655ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019656 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19657 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19658 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19659 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19660 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19661 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19662 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19663 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019664 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19665 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19666 LDAP v3.
19667 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19668 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019670ssl_c_serial : binary
19671 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19672 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19673 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019675ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19676 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
19677 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
19678 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019679 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
19680 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
19681
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019682 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019683 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019685ssl_c_sig_alg : string
19686 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19687 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19688 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019690ssl_c_used : boolean
19691 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
19692 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019694ssl_c_verify : integer
19695 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
19696 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
19697 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
19698 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019700ssl_c_version : integer
19701 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
19702 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019703
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010019704ssl_f_der : binary
19705 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
19706 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19707 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19708
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019709ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019710 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19711 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19712 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19713 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019714 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019715 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19716 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19717 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019718 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19719 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19720 LDAP v3.
19721 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19722 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019724ssl_f_key_alg : string
19725 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19726 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
19727 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019729ssl_f_notafter : string
19730 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19731 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19732 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019734ssl_f_notbefore : string
19735 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19736 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19737 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019738
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019739ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019740 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19741 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19742 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19743 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19744 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19745 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19746 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19747 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019748 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19749 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19750 LDAP v3.
19751 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19752 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019754ssl_f_serial : binary
19755 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19756 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19757 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019758
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019759ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19760 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19761 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19762 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019764ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19765 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19766 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19767 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019769ssl_f_version : integer
19770 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19771 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19772
19773ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019774 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19775 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19776 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019778 Example :
19779 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19780 listen http-https
19781 bind :80
19782 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19783 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19784
19785ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19786 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19787 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19788
19789ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019790 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019791 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019792 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019793 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19794 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19795 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19796 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19797 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19798 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019800ssl_fc_cipher : string
19801 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19802 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019803
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019804ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19805 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19806 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019807 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019808 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19809 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19810 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019811
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019812 Example:
19813 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19814 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19815 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19816 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19817 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19818 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19819 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19820 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19821 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19822
19823ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019824 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019825 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019826 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19827 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019828 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19829 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019830
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019831ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019832 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019833 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019834 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019835 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19836 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19837 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19838 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19839 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19840 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019841
19842ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019843 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019844 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19845 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019846
19847ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19848 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19849 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019850 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019851
19852 Example:
19853 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19854 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19855 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19856 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19857 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19858 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19859 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19860 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19861 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19862
19863ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19864 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19865 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019866 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019867 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19868 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19869 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19870
19871 Example:
19872 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19873 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19874 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19875 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19876 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19877 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19878 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19879 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19880 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19881
19882ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19883 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19884 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019885 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019886 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19887 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19888 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19889
19890 Example:
19891 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19892 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19893 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19894 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19895 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19896 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19897 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19898 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19899 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019900
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019901ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19902 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19903 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19904 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19905
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019906ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19907 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19908 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19909 transport layer.
19910 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19911 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19912 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19913 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19914
19915ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19916 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19917 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19918 transport layer.
19919 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19920 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19921 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19922 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19923
19924ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19925 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19926 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19927 transport layer.
19928 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19929 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19930 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19931 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19932
19933ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19934 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19935 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19936 transport layer.
19937 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19938 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19939 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19940 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19941
19942ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19943 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19944 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19945 transport layer.
19946 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19947 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19948 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19949 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19950
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019951ssl_fc_err : integer
19952 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19953 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19954 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
19955 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
19956 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
19957 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
19958 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
19959 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
19960 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
19961 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
19962 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
19963 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19964 codes.
19965
19966ssl_fc_err_str : string
19967 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19968 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19969 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19970 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19971 also "ssl_fc_err".
19972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019973ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019974 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19975 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019976 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19977 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19978 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19979 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019980
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019981ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19982 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19983 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19984 wait until the handshake happened.
19985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019986ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19987 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019988 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19989 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019990 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019991 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019992
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019993ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019994 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019995 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19996 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019998ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019999 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020000 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020001 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
20002 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
20003 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
20004 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
20005 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
20006 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020020007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020008ssl_fc_protocol : string
20009 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
20010 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020011
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020012ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
20013 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
20014 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020015 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
20016 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020017
20018 Example:
20019 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20020 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20021 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20022 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20023 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20024 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20025 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20026 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20027 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20028
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020029ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020030 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020031 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010020032 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020033
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020034ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20035 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20036 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20037 transport layer.
20038 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20039 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20040 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20041 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20042
20043ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
20044 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20045 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20046 transport layer.
20047 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20048 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20049 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20050 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20051
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020052ssl_fc_server_random : binary
20053 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20054 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20055 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020057ssl_fc_session_id : binary
20058 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
20059 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
20060 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
20061 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020062
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020063ssl_fc_session_key : binary
20064 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
20065 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20066 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
20067 BoringSSL.
20068
20069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020070ssl_fc_sni : string
20071 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
20072 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020073 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020074 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
20075 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
20076
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020077 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020078 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020079 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020080 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020020081 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020083 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020084 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
20085 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020020086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020087ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
20088 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
20089 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020090
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020091ssl_s_der : binary
20092 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
20093 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20094 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20095
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020096ssl_s_chain_der : binary
20097 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
20098 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20099 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020100 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020101 does not support resumed sessions.
20102
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020103ssl_s_key_alg : string
20104 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20105 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
20106 SSL/TLS transport layer.
20107
20108ssl_s_notafter : string
20109 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
20110 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20111 transport layer.
20112
20113ssl_s_notbefore : string
20114 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
20115 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20116 transport layer.
20117
20118ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20119 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20120 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20121 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20122 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20123 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20124 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020125 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20126 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020127 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20128 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20129 LDAP v3.
20130 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20131 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20132
20133ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20134 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20135 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20136 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20137 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20138 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20139 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020140 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20141 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020142 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20143 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20144 LDAP v3.
20145 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20146 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20147
20148ssl_s_serial : binary
20149 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
20150 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20151 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20152
20153ssl_s_sha1 : binary
20154 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
20155 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20156 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20157
20158ssl_s_sig_alg : string
20159 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20160 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20161 layer.
20162
20163ssl_s_version : integer
20164 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
20165 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020166
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200201677.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020168------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020170Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
20171sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
20172only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
20173For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
20174be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
20175can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
20176sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
20177for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
20178content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020179
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020180Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
20181 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020182 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020183 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
20184 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
20185 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
20186 sample expression). So be careful.
20187
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010020188distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
20189 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
20190 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
20191 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
20192 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
20193 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
20194 list of supported tokens.
20195
20196distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
20197 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
20198 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
20199 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
20200 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
20201 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
20202 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
20203 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
20204 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
20205 supported tokens.
20206
20207 Example :
20208 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
20209 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
20210 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
20211 # send large files to the big farm
20212 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
20213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020214payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020215 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020216 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
20217 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020219payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
20220 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020221 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020222 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020224req.len : integer
20225req_len : integer (deprecated)
20226 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20227 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20228 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20229 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20230 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020231 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020232 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
20233 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020235req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20236 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020237 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
20238 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
20239 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
20240 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020241
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020242 ACL derivatives :
20243 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020245req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20246 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20247 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20248 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
20249 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020250
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020251 ACL derivatives :
20252 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020254 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020256req.proto_http : boolean
20257req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
20258 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
20259 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
20260 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
20261 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
20262 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
20263 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
20264 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020266 Example:
20267 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
20268 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20269 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020270 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020272req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
20273rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20274 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
20275 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
20276 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
20277 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
20278 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
20279 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
20280 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020282 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
20283 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
20284 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
20285 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
20286 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
20287 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020289 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020290 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020292 Example :
20293 listen tse-farm
20294 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
20295 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
20296 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
20297 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
20298 # apply RDP cookie persistence
20299 persist rdp-cookie
20300 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
20301 # This is only useful makes sense if
20302 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
20303 stick-table type string size 204800
20304 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
20305 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
20306 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020308 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020309 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020311req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
20312rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
20313 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
20314 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
20315 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
20316 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020318 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020319 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020320
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020321req.ssl_alpn : string
20322 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
20323 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
20324 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
20325 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
20326 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
20327 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020328 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020329
20330 Examples :
20331 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20332 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020333 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020334 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020335 default_backend bk_default
20336
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020337req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
20338 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
20339 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020020340 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
20341 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
20342 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
20343 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
20344 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020346req.ssl_hello_type : integer
20347req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20348 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20349 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
20350 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20351 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20352 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
20353 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20354 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020356req.ssl_sni : string
20357req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
20358 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
20359 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
20360 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
20361 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20362 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020020363 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
20364 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
20365 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
20366 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
20367 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
20368 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
20369 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
20370 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
20371 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020373 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020374 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020376 Examples :
20377 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20378 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020379 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020380 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020381 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020382
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053020383req.ssl_st_ext : integer
20384 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
20385 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
20386 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
20387 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
20388 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
20389 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
20390 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
20391 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
20392 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
20393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020394req.ssl_ver : integer
20395req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
20396 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
20397 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
20398 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
20399 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
20400 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20401 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
20402 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020403 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020404 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020406 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020407 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020408
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020409res.len : integer
20410 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20411 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20412 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20413 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20414 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020415 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020416 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020417 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020419res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20420 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020421 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020422 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020423 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020424 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020426res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20427 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20428 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20429 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020430 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
20431 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020433 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020434
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020020435res.ssl_hello_type : integer
20436rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20437 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20438 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
20439 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20440 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20441 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
20442 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20443 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
20444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020445wait_end : boolean
20446 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
20447 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020448 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020449 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
20450 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020451 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020452 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
20453 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020455 Examples :
20456 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
20457 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
20458 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020460 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
20461 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20462 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
20463 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
20464 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
20465 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
20466 tcp-request content reject
20467
20468
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200204697.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020470--------------------------------------
20471
20472It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
20473This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
20474data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
20475its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
20476HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
20477content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
20478to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
20479more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
20480response are indexed.
20481
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010020482Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
20483 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
20484 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
20485 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
20486 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
20487 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
20488 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
20489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020490base : string
20491 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20492 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
20493 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
20494 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
20495 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
20496 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
20497 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
20498 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
20499
20500 ACL derivatives :
20501 base : exact string match
20502 base_beg : prefix match
20503 base_dir : subdir match
20504 base_dom : domain match
20505 base_end : suffix match
20506 base_len : length match
20507 base_reg : regex match
20508 base_sub : substring match
20509
20510base32 : integer
20511 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
20512 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
20513 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020020514 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
20515 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
20516 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020517
20518base32+src : binary
20519 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
20520 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
20521 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
20522 per-URL counters.
20523
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010020524baseq : string
20525 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20526 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
20527 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
20528 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
20529
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020530capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
20531 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
20532 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20533 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
20534
20535capture.req.method : string
20536 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
20537 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
20538 because it's allocated.
20539
20540capture.req.uri : string
20541 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
20542 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
20543 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
20544 allocated.
20545
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020546capture.req.ver : string
20547 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20548 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
20549 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
20550
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020551capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
20552 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
20553 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20554 The first entry is an index of 0.
20555 See also: "capture response header"
20556
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020557capture.res.ver : string
20558 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20559 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
20560 persistent flag.
20561
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020562req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020563 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
20564 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
20565 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020566
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020020567req.body_param([<name>) : string
20568 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
20569 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
20570 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
20571 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
20572 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
20573 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
20574 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
20575 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
20576 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
20577 given.
20578
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020579req.body_len : integer
20580 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
20581 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020582 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
20583 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020584
20585req.body_size : integer
20586 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020587 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20588 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020590req.cook([<name>]) : string
20591cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20592 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20593 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
20594 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
20595 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
20596 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
20597 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
20598 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
20599 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
20600
20601 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020602 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
20603 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
20604 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
20605 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
20606 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
20607 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
20608 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
20609 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020611req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20612cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20613 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20614 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020616req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20617cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20618 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20619 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
20620 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
20621 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020623cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20624 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20625 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20626 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20627 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020628 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020629 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20630 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20631 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20632 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020634hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20635 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20636 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20637 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20638 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020639 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020641req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020642 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20643 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20644 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20645 with headers such as User-Agent.
20646
20647 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20648 found.
20649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020650 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20651 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20652 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020653 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020655req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20656 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20657 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020658 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20659 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020661req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020662 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20663 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20664 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20665 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20666 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
20667 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
20668 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
20669
20670 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20671 found.
20672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020673 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20674 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20675 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020676 with -1 being the last one.
20677
20678 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
20679 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020681 ACL derivatives :
20682 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20683 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20684 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20685 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20686 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20687 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20688 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20689 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20690
20691req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20692hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
20693 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20694 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020695 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
20696 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
20697 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
20698
20699 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
20700 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
20701 which contain more than one of certain headers.
20702
20703 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020704
20705req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20706hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
20707 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
20708 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
20709 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010020710 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
20711 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
20712 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
20713 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
20714 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020715
20716 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20717
20718 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020719
20720req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20721hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
20722 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
20723 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
20724 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020725
20726 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20727
20728 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020729
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020730req.hdrs : string
20731 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
20732 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20733 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
20734 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20735
20736req.hdrs_bin : binary
20737 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20738 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
20739 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
20740 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
20741 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
20742 names and values (length of 0 for both).
20743
20744 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020745
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020746 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20747 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020749http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
20750 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
20751 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
20752 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20753 basic auth is supported.
20754
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020020755http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
20756 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
20757 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
20758 performed on the data sent by the client.
20759 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
20760 Authorization one.
20761
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020762http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
20763 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
20764 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
20765 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
20766 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020767 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20768 basic auth is supported.
20769
20770 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020771 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
20772 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20773 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20774 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020775
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020776http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020777 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20778 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20779 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020780
20781http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020782 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20783 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20784 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020785
20786http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020787 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20788 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20789 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020791http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020792 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20793 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020794 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20795 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020797method : integer + string
20798 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20799 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20800 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20801 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20802 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20803 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20804 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020806 ACL derivatives :
20807 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020809 Example :
20810 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20811 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20812 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020814path : string
20815 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20816 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20817 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20818 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20819 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020820 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020821 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020823 ACL derivatives :
20824 path : exact string match
20825 path_beg : prefix match
20826 path_dir : subdir match
20827 path_dom : domain match
20828 path_end : suffix match
20829 path_len : length match
20830 path_reg : regex match
20831 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020832
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020833pathq : string
20834 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20835 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20836 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20837 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20838 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20839 result in both cases.
20840
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020841query : string
20842 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20843 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20844 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20845 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020846 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020847 which stops before the question mark.
20848
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020849req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20850 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20851 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20852 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20853 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020855req.ver : string
20856req_ver : string (deprecated)
20857 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20858 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20859 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020861 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020862 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020863
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020864res.body : binary
20865 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20866 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020867 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20868
20869 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020870
20871res.body_len : integer
20872 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20873 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020874 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20875
20876 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020877
20878res.body_size : integer
20879 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20880 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20881 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20882 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020883 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20884
20885 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020886
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020887res.cache_hit : boolean
20888 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20889 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20890
20891res.cache_name : string
20892 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20893 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20894 empty string.
20895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020896res.comp : boolean
20897 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20898 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20899 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020901res.comp_algo : string
20902 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20903 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20904 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020906res.cook([<name>]) : string
20907scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20908 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20909 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020910 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20911
20912 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020914 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020915 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020917res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20918scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20919 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20920 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020921 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20922
20923 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020925res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20926scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20927 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20928 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020929 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20930
20931 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020933res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020934 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20935 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20936
20937 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20938 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20939
20940 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20941
20942 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020944res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020945 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20946 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20947
20948 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20949 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20950
20951 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020953res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20954shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020955 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20956 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20957
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020958 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020959 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20960
20961 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020963 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020964 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20965 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20966 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20967 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20968 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20969 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20970 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20971 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020972
20973res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20974shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020975 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20976 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20977
20978 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020979 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020980
20981 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020983res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20984shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020985 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20986 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20987
20988 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20989
20990 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020991
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020992res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20993 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20994 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20995 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020996 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20997
20998 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021000res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21001shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021002 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
21003 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21004
21005 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21006
21007 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021008
21009res.hdrs : string
21010 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
21011 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21012 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021013 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21014
21015 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021016
21017res.hdrs_bin : binary
21018 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21019 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
21020 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
21021 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
21022 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
21023 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
21024 (length of 0 for both).
21025
21026 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
21027
21028 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21029 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021031res.ver : string
21032resp_ver : string (deprecated)
21033 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021034 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
21035
21036 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021038 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021039 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021041set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21042 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21043 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021044 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021045 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021047 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
21048 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021050status : integer
21051 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
21052 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021053 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
21054
21055 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021056
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020021057unique-id : string
21058 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
21059 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
21060 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
21061 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
21062 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
21063 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
21064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021065url : string
21066 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
21067 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
21068 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
21069 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
21070 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
21071 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
21072 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021074 ACL derivatives :
21075 url : exact string match
21076 url_beg : prefix match
21077 url_dir : subdir match
21078 url_dom : domain match
21079 url_end : suffix match
21080 url_len : length match
21081 url_reg : regex match
21082 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021084url_ip : ip
21085 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
21086 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
21087 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
21088 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021089 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
21090 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021092url_port : integer
21093 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021094 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021095
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021096urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
21097url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021098 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
21099 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021100 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
21101 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
21102 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
21103 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021104 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
21105 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021106 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
21107 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021109 ACL derivatives :
21110 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
21111 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
21112 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
21113 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
21114 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
21115 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
21116 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
21117 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021118
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021120 Example :
21121 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
21122 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
21123 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
21124 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021125
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021126urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021127 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
21128 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
21129 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020021130
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020021131url32 : integer
21132 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
21133 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
21134 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
21135 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
21136 is an unsigned integer.
21137
21138url32+src : binary
21139 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
21140 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
21141 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
21142
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020021143
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200211447.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021145---------------------------------------
21146
21147This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
21148used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
21149purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
21150There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
21151or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
21152any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
21153for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
21154
21155internal.htx.data : integer
21156 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
21157 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21158
21159internal.htx.free : integer
21160 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
21161 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21162
21163internal.htx.free_data : integer
21164 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
21165 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21166
21167internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010021168 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
21169 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
21170 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021171
21172internal.htx.nbblks : integer
21173 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
21174 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21175
21176internal.htx.size : integer
21177 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
21178 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21179
21180internal.htx.used : integer
21181 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
21182 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21183 direction.
21184
21185internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
21186 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21187 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
21188 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
21189 of the special value :
21190 * head : The oldest inserted block
21191 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021192 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021193
21194internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
21195 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21196 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
21197 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
21198 integer or one of the special value :
21199 * head : The oldest inserted block
21200 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021201 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021202
21203internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
21204 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21205 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
21206 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21207 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21208
21209 * head : The oldest inserted block
21210 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021211 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021212
21213internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
21214 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21215 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21216 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21217 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21218
21219 * head : The oldest inserted block
21220 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021221 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021222
21223internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
21224 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21225 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21226 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21227 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21228
21229 * head : The oldest inserted block
21230 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021231 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021232
21233internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
21234 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
21235 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
21236 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21237 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21238
21239 * head : The oldest inserted block
21240 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021241 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021242
21243internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
21244 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
21245 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
21246 it returns false.
21247
21248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200212497.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021250---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021252Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
21253every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020021254order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021256ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021257---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
21258FALSE always_false never match
21259HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
21260HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
21261HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010021262HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021263HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
21264HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
21265HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
21266HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020021267LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021268METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
21269METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
21270METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
21271METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
21272METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
21273METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
21274METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
21275METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
21276RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
21277REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
21278TRUE always_true always match
21279WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
21280---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021281
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010021282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212838. Logging
21284----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021285
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021286One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
21287provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
21288very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
21289provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
21290state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021291to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021292headers.
21293
21294In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
21295about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
21296send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
21297
21298 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
21299 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
21300 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
21301 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
21302 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021303 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060021304 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021305
21306The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
21307allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
21308as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
21309while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
21310real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
21311delay.
21312
21313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213148.1. Log levels
21315---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021316
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021317TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021318source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021319HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
21320in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
21321track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
21322syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
21323about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021324
21325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213268.2. Log formats
21327----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021328
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021329HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021330and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
21331slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
21332options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021333
21334 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
21335 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
21336 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
21337 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
21338 extents.
21339
21340 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
21341 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
21342 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
21343 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
21344 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
21345
21346 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
21347 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
21348 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
21349 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
21350 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
21351
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020021352 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
21353 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
21354 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
21355 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
21356
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021357 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
21358
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021359Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
21360specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
21361field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
21362servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
21363always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
21364identifier.
21365
21366Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
21367 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
21368 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
21369 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
21370 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
21371
21372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213738.2.1. Default log format
21374-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021375
21376This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
21377as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
21378format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
21379
21380 Example :
21381 listen www
21382 mode http
21383 log global
21384 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21385
21386 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
21387 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
21388 (www/HTTP)
21389
21390 Field Format Extract from the example above
21391 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
21392 2 'Connect from' Connect from
21393 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
21394 4 'to' to
21395 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
21396 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
21397
21398Detailed fields description :
21399 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
21400 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
21401 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
21402 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
21403 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21404 and processed the connection.
21405 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
21406
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021407In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
21408"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
21409connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
21410
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021411It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
21412will eventually disappear.
21413
21414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214158.2.2. TCP log format
21416---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021417
21418The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
21419is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
21420information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
21421counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
21422emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
21423environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
21424the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
21425sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021426specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021427not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21428
21429The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21430exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021431if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021432
21433 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
21434 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21435 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
21436
21437A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
21438are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021439
21440 Example :
21441 frontend fnt
21442 mode tcp
21443 option tcplog
21444 log global
21445 default_backend bck
21446
21447 backend bck
21448 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21449
21450 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
21451 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
21452 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
21453
21454 Field Format Extract from the example above
21455 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
21456 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
21457 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
21458 4 frontend_name fnt
21459 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
21460 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
21461 7 bytes_read* 212
21462 8 termination_state --
21463 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
21464 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21465
21466Detailed fields description :
21467 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021468 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021469 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21470 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021471 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021472 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021473 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021474
21475 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021476 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21477 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21478 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021479
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021480 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021481 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
21482 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021483 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
21484 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
21485 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
21486 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021487
21488 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21489 and processed the connection.
21490
21491 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21492 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21493 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
21494 applications.
21495
21496 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21497 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21498 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21499 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
21500 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
21501
21502 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21503 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
21504 See "Timers" below for more details.
21505
21506 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21507 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
21508 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
21509 "Timers" below for more details.
21510
21511 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021512 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021513 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
21514 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
21515 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
21516 details.
21517
21518 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
21519 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
21520 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
21521 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
21522 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
21523
21524 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21525 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21526 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
21527 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
21528 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
21529 for more details.
21530
21531 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021532 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021533 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
21534 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
21535 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021536 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021537
21538 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21539 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21540 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21541 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21542 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21543 caused by a denial of service attack.
21544
21545 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21546 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21547 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21548 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21549 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21550 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21551 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21552 denial of service attack.
21553
21554 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21555 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21556 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21557 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21558 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21559 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21560 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21561 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
21562 be processed than on other servers.
21563
21564 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21565 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21566 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21567 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021568 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021569 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21570 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21571 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21572 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21573 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21574 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21575 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21576 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21577
21578 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21579 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21580 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21581 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21582 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21583 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021584 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021585 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21586
21587 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21588 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21589 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21590 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21591 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21592 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021593 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021594 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21595 occurs.
21596
21597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215988.2.3. HTTP log format
21599----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021600
21601The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
21602is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
21603the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
21604are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
21605emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
21606generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
21607"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
21608which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021609frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
21610is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021611
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021612The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21613exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021614if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021615
21616 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
21617 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21618 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
21619
21620And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
21621this exact string:
21622
21623 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
21624 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21625 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21626 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
21627
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021628Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
21629slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
21630with a star ('*') after the field name below.
21631
21632 Example :
21633 frontend http-in
21634 mode http
21635 option httplog
21636 log global
21637 default_backend bck
21638
21639 backend static
21640 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21641
21642 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21643 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
21644 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021645 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021646
21647 Field Format Extract from the example above
21648 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21649 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021650 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021651 4 frontend_name http-in
21652 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021653 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021654 7 status_code 200
21655 8 bytes_read* 2750
21656 9 captured_request_cookie -
21657 10 captured_response_cookie -
21658 11 termination_state ----
21659 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21660 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21661 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21662 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21663 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021664
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021665Detailed fields description :
21666 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021667 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021668 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21669 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021670 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021671 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021672 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021673
21674 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021675 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21676 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21677 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021678
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021679 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021680 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021681
21682 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21683 and processed the connection.
21684
21685 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21686 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21687 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
21688
21689 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21690 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21691 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21692 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
21693 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
21694 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
21695
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021696 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
21697 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
21698 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021699 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021700 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
21701 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021702 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021703 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021704
21705 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21706 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021707 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021708
21709 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21710 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021711 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
21712 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021713
21714 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
21715 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
21716 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
21717 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
21718 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021719 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
21720 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021721
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021722 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021723 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
21724 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
21725 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
21726 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
21727 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
21728 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021729 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021730
21731 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021732 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
21733 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021734
21735 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
21736 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021737 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021738 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
21739 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
21740 overflowing.
21741
21742 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
21743 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
21744 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
21745 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
21746 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
21747 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
21748 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
21749 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21750
21751 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
21752 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
21753 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
21754 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
21755 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
21756 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
21757 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
21758 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21759
21760 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21761 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21762 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
21763 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
21764 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
21765 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
21766 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
21767
21768 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021769 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021770 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
21771 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
21772 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021773 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021774 system.
21775
21776 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21777 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21778 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21779 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21780 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21781 caused by a denial of service attack.
21782
21783 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21784 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21785 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21786 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21787 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21788 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21789 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21790 denial of service attack.
21791
21792 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21793 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21794 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21795 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21796 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21797 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21798 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21799 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21800 processed than on other servers.
21801
21802 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21803 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21804 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21805 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021806 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021807 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21808 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21809 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21810 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21811 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21812 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21813 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21814 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21815
21816 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21817 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21818 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21819 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21820 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21821 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021822 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021823 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21824
21825 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21826 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21827 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21828 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21829 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21830 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021831 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021832 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21833 occurs.
21834
21835 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21836 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21837 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21838 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21839 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21840 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21841 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21842 cookies" below for more details.
21843
21844 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21845 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21846 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21847 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21848 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21849 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21850 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21851 and cookies" below for more details.
21852
21853 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21854 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21855 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21856 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21857 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21858 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21859 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21860 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21861
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021862
218638.2.4. HTTPS log format
21864----------------------
21865
21866The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21867extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21868information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21869frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21870end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21871matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21872sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21873dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21874"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21875
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021876The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21877exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021878if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021879
21880 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
21881 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21882 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21883 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021884 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021885
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021886This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21887appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21888HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021889
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021890 Example :
21891 frontend https-in
21892 mode http
21893 option httpslog
21894 log global
21895 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21896 default_backend bck
21897
21898 backend static
21899 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21900
21901 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21902 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21903 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021904 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
21905 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021906
21907 Field Format Extract from the example above
21908 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21909 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21910 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21911 4 frontend_name https-in
21912 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21913 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21914 7 status_code 200
21915 8 bytes_read* 2750
21916 9 captured_request_cookie -
21917 10 captured_response_cookie -
21918 11 termination_state ----
21919 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21920 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21921 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21922 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21923 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021924 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021925 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021926 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
21927 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021928
21929Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021930 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
21931 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
21932 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021933
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021934 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
21935 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
21936 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050021937 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021938 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021939
21940 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21941 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21942 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21943 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21944
21945 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21946 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21947 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21948 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21949
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021950 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
21951 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
21952 can be shared by multiple requests.
21953
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021954 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
21955 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
21956 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
21957 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
21958 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
21959
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021960 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21961
21962 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21963
21964
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100219658.2.5. Error log format
21966-----------------------
21967
21968When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
21969protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21970unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21971line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21972"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
21973will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
21974logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
21975
21976The default format looks like this :
21977
21978 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21979 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21980 Connection error during SSL handshake
21981
21982 Field Format Extract from the example above
21983 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21984 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21985 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21986 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21987 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21988
21989These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21990failures.
21991
21992By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
21993above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
21994defined format.
21995
21996An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
21997source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
21998number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
21999internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
22000error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
22001the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
22002certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
22003indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
22004indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
22005ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
22006are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
22007would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
22008regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
22009
22010 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010022011 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010022012 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
22013 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
22014
22015
220168.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022017------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022018
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022019When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
22020ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
22021a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
22022formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
22023looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
22024and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022025
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022026HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022027Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
22028separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
22029prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
22030
22031Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
22032variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022033("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022034
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022035If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020022036as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022037less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
22038the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
22039
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020022040Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
22041"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
22042delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
22043preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022044
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022045Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
22046'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
22047https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
22048such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
22049
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022050Flags are :
22051 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022052 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022053 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
22054 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022055
22056 Example:
22057
22058 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
22059 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
22060
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022061 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
22062
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022063Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
22064
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022065 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022066 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022067 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
22068 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
22069 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022070 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
22071 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
22072 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022073 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022074 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000022075 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000022076 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000022077 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022078 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
22079 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010022080 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020022081 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022082 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010022083 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022084 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020022085 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080022086 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022087 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
22088 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
22089 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
22090 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
22091 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022092 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022093 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022094 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022095 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022096 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022097 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
22098 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022099 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22100 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
22101 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022102 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022103 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
22104 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022105 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022106 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22107 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
22108 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020022109 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020022110 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022111 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
22112 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
22113 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
22114 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020022115 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022116 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022117 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022118 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010022119 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022120 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022121 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
22122 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
22123 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022124 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022125 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
22126 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022127 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022128 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
22129 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020022130 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022131 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022132 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022133 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022134
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022135 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022136
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010022137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221388.3. Advanced logging options
22139-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022140
22141Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
22142just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
22143options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
22144for more information about their usage.
22145
22146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221478.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
22148------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022149
22150It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022151HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022152commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
22153monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
22154ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
22155
22156 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
22157 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
22158 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
22159 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
22160
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020022161 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
22162 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022163
22164 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
22165 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
22166 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
22167
22168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221698.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
22170----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022171
22172The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
22173what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
22174or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022175"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022176just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
22177log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
22178after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
22179is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
22180with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
22181with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
22182
22183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221848.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
22185------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022186
22187Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
22188for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
22189"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
22190retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
22191raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
22192a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
22193file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
22194you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
22195"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
22196
22197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
22199--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022200
22201Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
22202multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
22203them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
22204"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
22205logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
22206error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
22207and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
22208too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
22209useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
22210alternative.
22211
22212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222138.4. Timing events
22214------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022215
22216Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
22217reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
22218the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
22219frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022220mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
22221addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
22222
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022223Timings events in HTTP mode:
22224
22225 first request 2nd request
22226 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
22227 t tr t tr ...
22228 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
22229 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
22230 :<---- Tq ---->: :
22231 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022232 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022233 :<--------- Ta --------->:
22234
22235Timings events in TCP mode:
22236
22237 TCP session
22238 |<----------------->|
22239 t t
22240 ---|----|----|----|----|---
22241 | Th Tw Tc Td |
22242 |<------ Tt ------->|
22243
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022244 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022245 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022246 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
22247 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
22248 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022249 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022250 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
22251 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
22252 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
22253 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022254
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022255 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
22256 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
22257 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022258 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
22259 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
22260 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
22261 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
22262 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
22263 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022264
22265 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
22266 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
22267 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
22268 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
22269 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
22270 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
22271 request typed by hand during a test.
22272
22273 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
22274 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022275 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022276 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
22277 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
22278 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
22279 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022280
22281 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
22282 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
22283 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
22284 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
22285 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
22286
22287 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
22288 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
22289 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
22290 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
22291 connection never established.
22292
22293 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
22294 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
22295 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
22296 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
22297 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
22298 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
22299 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
22300 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
22301 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
22302 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
22303 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
22304
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022305 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
22306 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
22307 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
22308 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
22309 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
22310 by subtracting other timers when valid :
22311
22312 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
22313
22314 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
22315 "Ta" can never be negative.
22316
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022317 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
22318 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022319 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
22320 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022321 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022322
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022323 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022324
22325 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022326 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
22327 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022328
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022329 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
22330 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
22331 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
22332 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
22333 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
22334 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
22335 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
22336 prefixed with a '+' sign.
22337
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022338These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
22339protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
22340that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022341due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
22342"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
22343that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022344
22345Most common cases :
22346
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022347 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
22348 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
22349 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
22350 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
22351 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022352 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022353 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
22354 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
22355 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
22356 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
22357 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020022358 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022359
22360 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
22361 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
22362 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
22363 of ms on remote networks.
22364
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022365 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
22366 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
22367 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022368
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022369 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
22370 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022371 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022372 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
22373 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
22374 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
22375 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
22376 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
22377 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022378
22379Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
22380
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022381 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022382 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022383 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022384
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022385 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022386 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
22387 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
22388
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022389 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022390 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
22391 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
22392 flags.
22393
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022394 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
22395 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022396 Check the session termination flags, then check the
22397 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
22398 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
22399 the client connection was maintained open.
22400
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022401 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022402 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022403 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022404 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
22405
22406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200224078.5. Session state at disconnection
22408-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022409
22410TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
22411"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
224122-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
22413each of which has a special meaning :
22414
22415 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
22416 session to terminate :
22417
22418 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
22419
22420 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
22421 server explicitly refused it.
22422
22423 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
22424 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
22425 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
22426 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022427 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022428
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022429 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022430 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022431
22432 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
22433 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
22434 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
22435 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
22436 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
22437
22438 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
22439 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
22440 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
22441 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
22442 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
22443
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022444 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090022445 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
22446
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022447 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070022448 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
22449 backup connections when going up.
22450
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022451 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020022452
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022453 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
22454 send or receive data.
22455
22456 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
22457 send or receive data.
22458
22459 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
22460 with nothing left in the buffers.
22461
22462 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
22463
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010022464 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022465 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
22466
22467 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
22468 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
22469 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
22470 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
22471 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
22472
22473 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
22474 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
22475
22476 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
22477 server (HTTP only).
22478
22479 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
22480
22481 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
22482 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
22483 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
22484
22485 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
22486 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
22487 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
22488
22489 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
22490
22491 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
22492 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
22493
22494 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
22495 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
22496 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
22497
22498 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
22499 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020022500 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
22501 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022502
22503 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
22504 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
22505 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
22506 another server.
22507
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022508 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022509 server.
22510
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022511 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
22512 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
22513 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
22514 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22515
22516 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
22517 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
22518 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
22519 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22520
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020022521 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
22522 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
22523 "use-server" rule).
22524
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022525 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22526
22527 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
22528 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
22529
22530 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
22531
22532 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
22533 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
22534 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
22535
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022536 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
22537 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022538 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022539 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
22540 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
22541
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022542 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
22543
22544 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
22545 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
22546
22547 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
22548
22549 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22550
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022551The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
22552was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022553helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
22554starvation, attacks, etc...
22555
22556The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
22557alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
22558easier finding and understanding.
22559
22560 Flags Reason
22561
22562 -- Normal termination.
22563
22564 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022565 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
22566 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022567 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
22568
22569 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
22570 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022571 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
22572 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022573 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
22574 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022575
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022576 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22577 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022578 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022579
22580 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
22581 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
22582 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
22583
22584 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
22585 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
22586 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
22587 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
22588 the server takes too long to respond.
22589
22590 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
22591 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
22592 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
22593 long a time to respond.
22594
22595 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
22596 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
22597 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022598 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022599 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
22600 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022601
22602 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
22603 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
22604 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
22605 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
22606 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020022607 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022608 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
22609 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
22610 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
22611 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
22612 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
22613 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
22614 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
22615 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022616 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022617 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
22618 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
22619 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022620
22621 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
22622 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022623 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
22624 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
22625 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
22626 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022627
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022628 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022629 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
22630
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022631 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022632 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
22633 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022634 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022635 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
22636 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
22637
22638 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
22639 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
22640 503 or 504 here.
22641
22642 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022643 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022644 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
22645 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
22646 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
22647
22648 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22649 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022650 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022651 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022652 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022653
22654 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
22655 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
22656 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
22657 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
22658 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
22659 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022660 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022661
22662 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
22663 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
22664 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
22665 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
22666 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
22667 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
22668 solution is to fix the application.
22669
22670 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
22671 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
22672 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
22673 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
22674 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
22675 external attacks.
22676
22677 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070022678 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022679 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022680 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
22681 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
22682
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022683 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
22684 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
22685 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022686 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020022687 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022688
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022689 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
22690 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
22691 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
22692 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022693 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
22694 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
22695 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
22696 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020022697 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
22698 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
22699 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
22700 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022701
22702 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
22703 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
22704 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020022705 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
22706 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
22707 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
22708 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022709
22710 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
22711 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
22712 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
22713 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
22714
22715 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
22716 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
22717 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
22718 only be solved by proper system tuning.
22719
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022720The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022721persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022722important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
22723re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
22724
22725 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
22726
22727 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22728 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
22729 set on a GET request.
22730
22731 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
22732 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022733 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022734 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
22735
22736 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
22737 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
22738 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
22739
22740 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22741 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
22742 already got a cookie.
22743
22744 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22745 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
22746 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
22747 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
22748 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
22749
22750 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22751 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22752 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22753
22754 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
22755 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22756 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22757
22758 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
22759 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
22760
22761 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
22762 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
22763 then advertised in the response.
22764
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227668.6. Non-printable characters
22767-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022768
22769In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
22770consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
22771converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
22772prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
22773being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
22774escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
22775is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
22776'}' when logging headers.
22777
22778Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
22779issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
22780containing spaces is "User-Agent".
22781
22782Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
22783the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
22784performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
22785
22786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227878.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
22788---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022789
22790Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
22791achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022792section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022793cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
22794the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
22795the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022796locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022797not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
22798user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
22799a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
22800wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
22801
22802 Examples :
22803 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
22804 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
22805
22806 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
22807 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
22808
22809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
22811---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022812
22813Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
22814proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
22815the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
22816server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
22817
22818Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
22819response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022820section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022821
22822It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022823time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
22824appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022825are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
22826and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
22827follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
22828request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
22829in the logs.
22830
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022831As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22832frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22833an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22834
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022835 Example :
22836 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22837 listen proxy-out
22838 mode http
22839 option httplog
22840 option logasap
22841 log global
22842 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22843
22844 # log the name of the virtual server
22845 capture request header Host len 20
22846
22847 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22848 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22849
22850 # log the beginning of the referrer
22851 capture request header Referer len 20
22852
22853 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22854 capture response header Server len 20
22855
22856 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22857 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22858
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022859 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022860 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22861
22862 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22863 capture response header Via len 20
22864
22865 # log the URL location during a redirection
22866 capture response header Location len 20
22867
22868 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22869 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22870 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22871 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22872 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22873
22874 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22875 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22876 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22877 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022878 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022879
22880 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22881 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22882 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22883 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22884 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022885 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022886
22887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228888.9. Examples of logs
22889---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022890
22891These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22892them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22893reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22894
22895 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22896 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22897 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22898
22899 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22900 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22901
22902 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22903 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22904 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22905
22906 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22907 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22908
22909 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22910 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22911 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22912
22913 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022914 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022915 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22916 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22917
22918 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22919 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22920 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22921
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022922 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22923 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22924 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22925 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022926 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022927 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022928
22929 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022930 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022931
22932 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22933 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22934 Nothing was sent to any server.
22935
22936 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22937 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22938
22939 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22940 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022941 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022942 send a 408 return code to the client.
22943
22944 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22945 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22946
22947 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22948 5 seconds ("c----").
22949
22950 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22951 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022952 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022953
22954 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022955 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022956 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22957 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22958 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22959 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22960 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022961
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022962
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200229639. Supported filters
22964--------------------
22965
22966Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22967accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22968unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22969
22970See also : "filter"
22971
229729.1. Trace
22973----------
22974
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022975filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022976
22977 Arguments:
22978 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22979 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22980
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022981 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022982
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022983 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022984 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22985 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22986 amount of the parsed data.
22987
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022988 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022989
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022990This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22991callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22992information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22993filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22994
22995Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22996tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22997a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22998
22999
230009.2. HTTP compression
23001---------------------
23002
23003filter compression
23004
23005The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
23006keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023007when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
23008fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
23009done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
23010explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
23011filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
23012listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23013order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023014
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023015See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
23016 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023017
23018
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200230199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
23020--------------------------------------------
23021
23022filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
23023
23024 Arguments :
23025
23026 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
23027 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
23028 parsed.
23029
23030 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
23031 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
23032 part must be placed in its own scope.
23033
23034The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
23035external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023036streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023037exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
23038also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
23039
23040SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
23041the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
23042
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010023043For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023044"doc/SPOE.txt".
23045
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100230469.4. Cache
23047----------
23048
23049filter cache <name>
23050
23051 Arguments :
23052
23053 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
23054
23055The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
23056"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023057cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023058other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
23059case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
23060is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
23061filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010023062listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23063order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010023064
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023065See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
23066 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
23067
23068
230699.5. Fcgi-app
23070-------------
23071
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023072filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023073
23074 Arguments :
23075
23076 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
23077
23078The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
23079request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
23080reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
23081used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
23082implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
23083used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
23084fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
23085used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23086order.
23087
23088See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
23089 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
23090
23091
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100230929.6. OpenTracing
23093----------------
23094
23095The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
23096HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
23097of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
23098Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
23099
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023100This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023101
23102The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
23103HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
23104participates in the work of HAProxy.
23105
23106filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
23107
23108 Arguments :
23109
23110 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
23111 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
23112 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
23113 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
23114 OpenTracing filters.
23115
23116 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
23117 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
23118 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
23119 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
23120 filter must have its own scope defined.
23121
23122More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020023123of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023124
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200231259.7. Bandwidth limitation
23126--------------------------
23127
23128filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23129filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23130filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23131filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23132
23133 Arguments :
23134
23135 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
23136 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
23137
23138 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
23139 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23140 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23141 expressed in bytes.
23142
23143 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
23144 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
23145 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
23146 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23147
23148 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
23149 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
23150 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23151
23152 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023153 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023154 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
23155 is expressed in milliseconds.
23156
23157 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
23158 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
23159 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23160 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23161 expressed in bytes.
23162
23163Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
23164speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
23165bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
23166used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
23167sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
23168other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
23169connections for a given client.
23170
23171The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
23172filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
23173definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
23174the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
23175compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
23176the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
23177for the cache filter.
23178
23179There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
23180default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
23181to enfore a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
23182the table.
23183
23184In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
23185limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
23186forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
23187the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
23188used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
23189cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
23190level.
23191
23192The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
23193connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
23194of the same connection may have different limits.
23195
23196For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
23197defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
23198bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
23199only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
23200when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
23201
23202For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
23203incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
23204corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23205stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23206used to limit outgoing data.
23207
23208Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
23209limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
23210to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
23211carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
23212it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
23213limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
23214experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
23215a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
23216start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
23217some experimentations.
23218
23219 Example:
23220 frontend http
23221 bind *:80
23222 mode http
23223
23224 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
23225 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
23226 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
23227
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023228 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023229 # independently of all other streams.
23230 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
23231
23232 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
23233 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
23234 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
23235 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
23236 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
23237 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
23238 ...
23239
23240 backend limit-by-src
23241 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
23242 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
23243
23244See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
23245 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
23246 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
23247 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023248
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002324910. FastCGI applications
23250-------------------------
23251
23252HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
23253feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
23254the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
23255FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
23256servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
23257FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
23258backend.
23259
23260HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
23261application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
23262connection.
23263
2326410.1. Setup
23265-----------
23266
2326710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
23268--------------------------
23269
23270fcgi-app <name>
23271 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
23272 document root must be defined.
23273
23274acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
23275 Declare or complete an access list.
23276
23277 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
23278 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
23279 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
23280 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
23281 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
23282
23283docroot <path>
23284 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
23285 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
23286 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
23287
23288index <script-name>
23289 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
23290 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
23291 is an optional setting.
23292
23293 Example :
23294 index index.php
23295
23296log-stderr global
23297log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010023298 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023299 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
23300
23301 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
23302 default STDERR messages are ignored.
23303
23304pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23305 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
23306 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
23307 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23308
23309 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
23310 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
23311 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
23312 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
23313
23314 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
23315 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
23316
23317path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023318 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023319 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
23320 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
23321 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
23322 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
23323 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
23324 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
23325 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023326
23327 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023328 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023329 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
23330 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
23331 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
23332 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023333
23334 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023335 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
23336 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023337
23338option get-values
23339no option get-values
23340 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
23341
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023342 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023343 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
23344
23345 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
23346 application will accept.
23347
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020023348 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
23349 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023350
23351 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050023352 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023353 option is disabled.
23354
23355 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
23356 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
23357 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
23358 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
23359 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
23360 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
23361
23362option keep-conn
23363no option keep-conn
23364 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
23365 sending a response.
23366
23367 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
23368 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
23369
23370option max-reqs <reqs>
23371 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
23372 accept.
23373
23374 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
23375 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
23376 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
23377 to 1.
23378
23379option mpxs-conns
23380no option mpxs-conns
23381 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
23382
23383 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
23384 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
23385
23386set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23387 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
23388 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
23389 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
23390 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23391
23392 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
23393 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
23394 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
23395
23396 Example :
23397 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
23398 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
23399
23400 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
23401
23402
2340310.1.2. Proxy section
23404---------------------
23405
23406use-fcgi-app <name>
23407 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
23408
23409 Arguments :
23410 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
23411
23412 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
23413 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
23414 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
23415 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
23416 application may be defined at a time per backend.
23417
23418 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
23419 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
23420 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
23421 application are evaluated.
23422
23423
2342410.1.3. Example
23425---------------
23426
23427 frontend front-http
23428 mode http
23429 bind *:80
23430 bind *:
23431
23432 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
23433 default_backend back-static
23434
23435 backend back-static
23436 mode http
23437 server www A.B.C.D:80
23438
23439 backend back-dynamic
23440 mode http
23441 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
23442 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
23443
23444 fcgi-app php-fpm
23445 log-stderr global
23446 option keep-conn
23447
23448 docroot /var/www/my-app
23449 index index.php
23450 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
23451
23452
2345310.2. Default parameters
23454------------------------
23455
23456A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
23457the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023458script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023459applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
23460
23461 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23462 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
23463 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
23464 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
23465 | | |
23466 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23467 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
23468 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
23469 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
23470 | | application. |
23471 | | |
23472 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23473 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
23474 | | the request. It may not be set. |
23475 | | |
23476 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23477 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
23478 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
23479 | | the application's configuration. |
23480 | | |
23481 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23482 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
23483 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
23484 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
23485 | | |
23486 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23487 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
23488 | | following the part that identifies the script |
23489 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
23490 | | be defined. |
23491 | | |
23492 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23493 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
23494 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
23495 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
23496 | | is not set too. |
23497 | | |
23498 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23499 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
23500 | | set. |
23501 | | |
23502 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23503 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
23504 | | the request. |
23505 | | |
23506 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23507 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
23508 | | client as part of user authentication. |
23509 | | |
23510 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23511 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
23512 | | script to process the request. |
23513 | | |
23514 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23515 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
23516 | | |
23517 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23518 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
23519 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
23520 | | |
23521 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23522 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
23523 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
23524 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
23525 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
23526 | | |
23527 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23528 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
23529 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
23530 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
23531 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
23532 | | side. |
23533 | | |
23534 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23535 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
23536 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
23537 | | connected to. |
23538 | | |
23539 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23540 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
23541 | | |
23542 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020023543 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
23544 | | current HAProxy version. |
23545 | | |
23546 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023547 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
23548 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
23549 | | |
23550 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23551
23552
2355310.3. Limitations
23554------------------
23555
23556The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
23557way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
23558during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
23559establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
23560application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
23561or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
23562message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
23563these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
23564and HTTP servers under the same backend.
23565
23566Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
23567request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
23568requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
23569
23570About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
23571into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
23572fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
23573"http-request" ones.
23574
23575Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
23576FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
23577processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
23578must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
23579here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010023580
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020023581
2358211. Address formats
23583-------------------
23584
23585Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
23586address.
23587
23588This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
23589The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
23590of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
23591equivalent is '::'.
23592
23593Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
23594is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
23595
23596This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
23597family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
23598
23599Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
23600configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
23601use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
23602'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
23603
23604Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
23605socket type and the transport method.
23606
23607
2360811.1 Address family prefixes
23609----------------------------
23610
23611'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
23612
23613'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
23614 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
23615 listening.
23616
23617'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
23618 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
23619 on the statement using this address, a port or
23620 a port range may or must be specified.
23621
23622'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23623 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
23624 using this address, a port or a port range
23625 may or must be specified.
23626
23627'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23628 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
23629 using this address, a port or a port range
23630 may or must be specified.
23631
23632'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
23633 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
23634 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
23635 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
23636 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
23637 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
23638
23639'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
23640 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
23641 start by slash '/'.
23642
23643
2364411.2 Socket type prefixes
23645-------------------------
23646
23647Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
23648type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
23649this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
23650This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
23651but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
23652
23653Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
23654instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
23655
23656If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
23657they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
23658report this to the maintainers.
23659
23660'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23661 to "stream"
23662
23663'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23664 to "datagram".
23665
23666
2366711.3 Protocol prefixes
23668----------------------
23669
23670'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23671 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23672 socket type and transport method is forced to
23673 "stream". Depending on the statement using
23674 this address, a port or a port range can or
23675 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23676 of 'stream+ip@'.
23677
23678'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23679 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23680 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23681 statement using this address, a port or port
23682 range can or must be specified.
23683 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23684
23685'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23686 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23687 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23688 statement using this address, a port or port
23689 range can or must be specified.
23690 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23691
23692'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23693 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23694 socket type and transport method is forced to
23695 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
23696 this address, a port or a port range can or
23697 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23698 of 'dgram+ip@'.
23699
23700'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23701 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23702 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23703 the statement using this address, a port or
23704 port range can or must be specified.
23705 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23706
23707'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23708 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23709 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23710 the statement using this address, a port or
23711 port range can or must be specified.
23712 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23713
23714'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23715 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
23716 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
23717
23718'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23719 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
23720 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
23721
23722In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
23723QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
23724
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010023725/*
23726 * Local variables:
23727 * fill-column: 79
23728 * End:
23729 */